*** empty log message ***
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob842a81afc382bbc57414165159e757e15604033b
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 1999, 2000, 01, 02, 2003
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
25 #include <config.h>
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
31 #include <stdio.h>
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
135 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
138 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
139 #ifndef XtNpickTop
140 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
141 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
142 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
143 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
145 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
147 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
148 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #endif
152 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
153 #include "widget.h"
154 #ifndef XtNinitialState
155 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
156 #endif
157 #endif
159 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
161 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
162 int use_xim = 1;
165 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
167 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
169 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
170 start. */
172 static int any_help_event_p;
174 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
175 static Lisp_Object last_window;
177 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
179 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
181 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
182 use. */
184 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
186 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
187 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
188 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
189 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
191 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
193 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
194 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
195 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
196 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
198 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
200 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
202 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
204 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
205 /* The application context for Xt use. */
206 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
207 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
208 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
210 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
212 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
214 /* Mouse movement.
216 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
217 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
218 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
219 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
221 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
223 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
224 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
225 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
226 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
227 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
228 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
229 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
230 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
231 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
232 is off. */
234 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
236 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
237 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
239 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
241 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
242 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
243 an ordinary motion.
245 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
246 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
247 event. */
249 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
251 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
252 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
253 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
254 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
255 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
256 it's somewhat accurate. */
258 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
260 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
261 events. */
263 #ifdef __STDC__
264 static int volatile input_signal_count;
265 #else
266 static int input_signal_count;
267 #endif
269 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
271 static int x_noop_count;
273 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
275 extern char **initial_argv;
276 extern int initial_argc;
278 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
280 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
282 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
284 extern Lisp_Object Qface, Qmouse_face, Qeql;
286 extern int errno;
288 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
290 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
292 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
294 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
295 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
296 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
298 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
299 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1, Qutf_8;
301 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
304 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
305 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
306 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
307 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
308 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
309 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
310 unsigned));
311 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
312 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
313 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
314 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
315 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
316 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
317 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
318 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
319 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
320 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
321 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
322 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
323 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
324 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
325 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
326 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
327 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
328 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
329 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
330 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
331 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
332 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
333 static int x_focus_changed P_ ((int,
334 int,
335 struct x_display_info *,
336 struct frame *,
337 struct input_event *,
338 int));
339 static int x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
340 XEvent *,
341 struct input_event *,
342 int));
343 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
345 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
346 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
347 enum text_cursor_kinds));
349 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, GC));
350 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
351 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
352 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
353 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
354 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Window));
355 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
356 enum scroll_bar_part *,
357 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
358 unsigned long *));
359 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
360 static void x_check_fullscreen_move P_ ((struct frame *));
361 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
362 XEvent *,
363 struct input_event **,
364 int *,
365 int *));
368 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
370 static void
371 x_flush (f)
372 struct frame *f;
374 BLOCK_INPUT;
375 if (f == NULL)
377 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
378 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
379 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
381 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
382 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
387 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
388 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
389 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
390 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
391 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
392 performance. */
394 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
397 /***********************************************************************
398 Debugging
399 ***********************************************************************/
401 #if 0
403 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
404 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
406 struct record
408 char *locus;
409 int type;
412 struct record event_record[100];
414 int event_record_index;
416 record_event (locus, type)
417 char *locus;
418 int type;
420 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
421 event_record_index = 0;
423 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
424 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
425 event_record_index++;
428 #endif /* 0 */
432 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
434 struct x_display_info *
435 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
436 Display *dpy;
438 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
440 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
441 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
442 return dpyinfo;
444 return 0;
449 /***********************************************************************
450 Starting and ending an update
451 ***********************************************************************/
453 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
454 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
455 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
456 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
457 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
459 static void
460 x_update_begin (f)
461 struct frame *f;
463 /* Nothing to do. */
467 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
468 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
469 position of W. */
471 static void
472 x_update_window_begin (w)
473 struct window *w;
475 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
476 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
478 updated_window = w;
479 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
481 BLOCK_INPUT;
483 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
485 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
486 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
488 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
489 highlighting. */
490 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
491 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
493 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
494 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
495 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
496 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
497 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
498 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
500 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
501 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
502 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
503 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
504 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
505 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
506 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
508 int i;
510 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
511 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
512 break;
514 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
515 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
517 #endif /* 0 */
520 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
524 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
526 static void
527 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
528 struct window *w;
529 int x, y0, y1;
531 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
533 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
534 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
537 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
539 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
540 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
542 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
543 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
544 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
546 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
547 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
548 here. */
550 static void
551 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
552 struct window *w;
553 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
555 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
557 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
559 BLOCK_INPUT;
561 if (cursor_on_p)
562 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
563 output_cursor.vpos,
564 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
566 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
567 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
570 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
571 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
572 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
574 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
575 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
576 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
579 updated_window = NULL;
583 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
584 update_end. */
586 static void
587 x_update_end (f)
588 struct frame *f;
590 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
591 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
593 #ifndef XFlush
594 BLOCK_INPUT;
595 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
596 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
597 #endif
601 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
602 complete update has been performed. The global variable
603 updated_window is not available here. */
605 static void
606 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
607 struct frame *f;
609 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
611 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
613 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
614 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
616 BLOCK_INPUT;
617 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
618 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
619 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
620 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
621 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
622 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
628 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
629 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
630 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
631 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
632 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
633 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
635 static void
636 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
637 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
639 struct window *w = updated_window;
640 struct frame *f;
641 int width, height;
643 xassert (w);
645 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
647 BLOCK_INPUT;
648 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, desired_row);
649 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
652 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
653 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
654 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
655 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
656 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
657 overhead is very small. */
658 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
659 && desired_row->full_width_p
660 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
661 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
662 width != 0)
663 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
664 height > 0))
666 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
668 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
669 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
670 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
671 y -= width;
673 BLOCK_INPUT;
674 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
675 0, y, width, height, False);
676 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
677 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
678 y, width, height, False);
679 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
683 static void
684 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
685 struct window *w;
686 struct glyph_row *row;
687 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
689 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
690 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
691 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
692 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
693 struct face *face = p->face;
695 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
696 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
698 if (p->bx >= 0)
700 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
701 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
702 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
703 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
704 if (face->stipple)
705 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
706 else
707 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
709 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
710 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
712 if (!face->stipple)
713 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
716 if (p->which != NO_FRINGE_BITMAP)
718 unsigned char *bits = fringe_bitmaps[p->which].bits + p->dh;
719 Pixmap pixmap;
720 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
722 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
723 by the server. */
724 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
725 face->foreground,
726 face->background, depth);
727 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
728 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
729 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
732 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
737 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
738 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
739 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
740 rarely happens). */
742 static void
743 XTset_terminal_modes ()
747 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
748 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
750 static void
751 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
757 /***********************************************************************
758 Display Iterator
759 ***********************************************************************/
761 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
763 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
766 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
767 is not contained in the font. */
769 static XCharStruct *
770 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
771 XFontStruct *font;
772 XChar2b *char2b;
773 int font_type; /* unused on X */
775 /* The result metric information. */
776 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
778 xassert (font && char2b);
780 if (font->per_char != NULL)
782 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
784 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
785 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
786 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
787 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
788 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
789 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
790 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
791 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
792 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
793 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
795 else
797 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
798 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
799 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
800 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
802 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
803 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
805 where:
807 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
808 / = integer division
809 \ = integer modulus */
810 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
811 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
812 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
813 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
815 pcm = (font->per_char
816 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
817 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
818 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
822 else
824 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
825 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
826 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
827 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
828 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
829 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
832 return ((pcm == NULL
833 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
834 ? NULL : pcm);
838 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
839 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
841 static int
842 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
843 int c;
844 XChar2b *char2b;
845 struct font_info *font_info;
846 int *two_byte_p;
848 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
849 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
851 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
852 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
853 fixed encoding. */
854 if (font_info->font_encoder)
856 /* It's a program. */
857 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
859 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
861 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
862 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
863 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
865 else
867 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
868 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
869 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
872 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
874 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
875 program. */
876 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
877 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
878 else
879 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
881 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
883 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
884 encoding numbers. */
885 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
887 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
888 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
889 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
891 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
892 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
895 if (two_byte_p)
896 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
898 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
903 /***********************************************************************
904 Glyph display
905 ***********************************************************************/
909 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
910 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
911 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
912 int));
913 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
914 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
915 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
916 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
917 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
918 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
919 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
920 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
921 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
922 unsigned long *, double, int));
923 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
924 double, int, unsigned long));
925 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
926 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
927 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
928 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
929 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
930 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
931 int, int, int));
932 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
933 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
934 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
935 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
937 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
938 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
939 #endif
942 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
943 face. */
945 static void
946 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
947 struct glyph_string *s;
949 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
950 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
951 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
952 && !s->cmp)
953 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
954 else
956 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
957 XGCValues xgcv;
958 unsigned long mask;
960 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
961 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
963 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
964 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
965 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
966 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
967 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
968 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
969 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
971 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
972 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
973 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
975 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
976 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
979 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
980 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
981 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
982 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
984 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
985 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
986 mask, &xgcv);
987 else
988 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
989 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
991 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
996 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
998 static void
999 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1000 struct glyph_string *s;
1002 int face_id;
1003 struct face *face;
1005 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1006 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1007 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1008 if (face == NULL)
1009 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1011 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1012 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1013 else
1014 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1015 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1016 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1018 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1019 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1020 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1021 else
1023 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1024 but font FONT. */
1025 XGCValues xgcv;
1026 unsigned long mask;
1028 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1029 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1030 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1031 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1032 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1033 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1035 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1036 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1037 mask, &xgcv);
1038 else
1039 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1040 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1042 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1045 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1049 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1050 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1051 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1053 static INLINE void
1054 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1055 struct glyph_string *s;
1057 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1062 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1063 pattern. */
1065 static INLINE void
1066 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1067 struct glyph_string *s;
1069 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1071 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1073 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1074 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1076 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1078 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1079 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1081 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1083 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1084 s->stippled_p = 0;
1086 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1088 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1089 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1091 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1092 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1094 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1095 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1097 else
1099 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1100 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1103 /* GC must have been set. */
1104 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1108 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1109 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1111 static INLINE void
1112 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1113 struct glyph_string *s;
1115 XRectangle r;
1116 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1117 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1121 /* RIF:
1122 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1123 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1125 static void
1126 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1127 struct glyph_string *s;
1129 if (s->cmp == NULL
1130 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1132 XCharStruct cs;
1133 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1134 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1135 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1136 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1137 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1142 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1144 static INLINE void
1145 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1146 struct glyph_string *s;
1147 int x, y, w, h;
1149 XGCValues xgcv;
1150 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1151 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1152 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1153 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1157 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1158 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1159 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1160 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1161 contains the first component of a composition. */
1163 static void
1164 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1165 struct glyph_string *s;
1166 int force_p;
1168 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1169 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1170 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1172 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1174 if (s->stippled_p)
1176 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1177 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1178 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1179 s->y + box_line_width,
1180 s->background_width,
1181 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1182 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1183 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1185 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1186 || s->font_not_found_p
1187 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1188 || force_p)
1190 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1191 s->background_width,
1192 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1193 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1199 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1201 static void
1202 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1203 struct glyph_string *s;
1205 int i, x;
1207 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1208 of S to the right of that box line. */
1209 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1210 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1211 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1212 else
1213 x = s->x;
1215 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1216 loaded. */
1217 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1219 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1221 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1222 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1223 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1224 s->height - 1);
1225 x += g->pixel_width;
1228 else
1230 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1231 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1233 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1234 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1236 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1237 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1238 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1239 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1241 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1242 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1243 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1244 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1245 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1246 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1247 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1249 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1250 if (s->two_byte_p)
1251 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1252 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1253 else
1254 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1255 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1257 else
1259 if (s->two_byte_p)
1260 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1261 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1262 else
1263 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1264 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1267 if (s->face->overstrike)
1269 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1270 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1271 if (s->two_byte_p)
1272 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1273 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1274 else
1275 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1276 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1281 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1283 static void
1284 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1285 struct glyph_string *s;
1287 int i, x;
1289 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1290 of S to the right of that box line. */
1291 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1292 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1293 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1294 else
1295 x = s->x;
1297 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1298 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1299 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1300 this composition. */
1302 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1303 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1304 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1306 if (s->gidx == 0)
1307 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1308 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1310 else
1312 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1314 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1315 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1316 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1317 s->char2b + i, 1);
1318 if (s->face->overstrike)
1319 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1320 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1321 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1322 s->char2b + i, 1);
1328 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1330 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1331 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1332 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1333 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1334 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1337 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1338 cannot be determined. */
1340 static struct frame *
1341 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1342 Widget widget;
1344 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1345 Lisp_Object tail;
1346 struct frame *f;
1348 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1350 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1351 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1352 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1353 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1354 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1355 widget = XtParent (widget);
1357 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1358 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1359 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1360 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1361 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1362 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1363 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1364 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1365 return f;
1367 abort ();
1371 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1372 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1373 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1374 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1377 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1378 Widget widget;
1379 Colormap cmap;
1380 XColor *color;
1382 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1383 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1387 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1388 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1389 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1390 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1391 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1392 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1395 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1396 Widget widget;
1397 Display *display;
1398 Colormap cmap;
1399 unsigned long *pixel;
1400 double factor;
1401 int delta;
1403 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1404 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1408 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1409 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1411 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1413 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1414 sizeof (Screen *)},
1415 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1416 sizeof (Colormap)}
1420 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1421 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1423 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1426 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1428 DPY is the display we are working on.
1430 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1431 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1432 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1433 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1435 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1436 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1438 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1439 we allocated the color or not.
1441 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1443 static Boolean
1444 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1445 Display *dpy;
1446 XrmValue *args;
1447 Cardinal *nargs;
1448 XrmValue *from, *to;
1449 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1451 Screen *screen;
1452 Colormap cmap;
1453 Pixel pixel;
1454 String color_name;
1455 XColor color;
1457 if (*nargs != 2)
1459 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1460 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1461 "XtToolkitError",
1462 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1463 return False;
1466 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1467 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1468 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1470 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1472 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1473 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1475 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1477 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1478 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1480 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1481 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1483 pixel = color.pixel;
1484 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1486 else
1488 String params[1];
1489 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1491 params[0] = color_name;
1492 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1493 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1494 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1495 params, &nparams);
1496 return False;
1499 if (to->addr != NULL)
1501 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1503 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1504 return False;
1507 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1509 else
1511 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1512 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1515 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1516 return True;
1520 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1521 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1522 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1524 APP is the application context in which we work.
1526 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1527 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1528 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1530 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1532 static void
1533 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1534 XtAppContext app;
1535 XrmValuePtr to;
1536 XtPointer closure;
1537 XrmValuePtr args;
1538 Cardinal *nargs;
1540 if (*nargs != 2)
1542 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1543 "XtToolkitError",
1544 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1545 NULL, NULL);
1547 else if (closure != NULL)
1549 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1550 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1551 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1552 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1553 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1558 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1561 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1562 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1563 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1564 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1566 static const XColor *
1567 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1568 Display *dpy;
1569 int *ncells;
1571 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1573 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1575 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1576 int i;
1578 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1579 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1580 dpyinfo->color_cells
1581 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1582 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1584 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1585 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1587 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1588 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1591 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1592 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1596 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1597 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1599 void
1600 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1601 struct frame *f;
1602 XColor *colors;
1603 int ncolors;
1605 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1607 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1609 int i;
1610 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1612 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1613 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1614 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1615 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1618 else
1619 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1623 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1624 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1626 void
1627 x_query_color (f, color)
1628 struct frame *f;
1629 XColor *color;
1631 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1635 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1636 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1637 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1638 allocated. */
1640 static int
1641 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1642 Display *dpy;
1643 Colormap cmap;
1644 XColor *color;
1646 int rc;
1648 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1649 if (rc == 0)
1651 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1652 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1653 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1654 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1655 int nearest, i;
1656 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1657 int ncells;
1658 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1660 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1662 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1663 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1664 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1665 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1667 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1669 nearest = i;
1670 nearest_delta = delta;
1674 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1675 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1676 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1677 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1679 else
1681 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1682 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1683 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1684 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1685 XColor *cached_color;
1687 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1688 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1689 (cached_color->red != color->red
1690 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1691 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1693 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1694 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1695 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1699 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1700 if (rc)
1701 register_color (color->pixel);
1702 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1704 return rc;
1708 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1709 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1710 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1711 allocated. */
1714 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1715 struct frame *f;
1716 Colormap cmap;
1717 XColor *color;
1719 gamma_correct (f, color);
1720 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1724 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1725 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1726 get color reference counts right. */
1728 unsigned long
1729 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1730 struct frame *f;
1731 unsigned long pixel;
1733 XColor color;
1735 color.pixel = pixel;
1736 BLOCK_INPUT;
1737 x_query_color (f, &color);
1738 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1739 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1740 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1741 register_color (pixel);
1742 #endif
1743 return color.pixel;
1747 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1748 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1749 get color reference counts right. */
1751 unsigned long
1752 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1753 Display *dpy;
1754 Colormap cmap;
1755 unsigned long pixel;
1757 XColor color;
1759 color.pixel = pixel;
1760 BLOCK_INPUT;
1761 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1762 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1763 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1764 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1765 register_color (pixel);
1766 #endif
1767 return color.pixel;
1771 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1772 boosted.
1774 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1775 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1776 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1777 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1778 use an additional additive factor.
1780 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1781 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1782 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1785 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1786 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1787 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1788 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1789 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1790 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1792 static int
1793 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1794 struct frame *f;
1795 Display *display;
1796 Colormap cmap;
1797 unsigned long *pixel;
1798 double factor;
1799 int delta;
1801 XColor color, new;
1802 long bright;
1803 int success_p;
1805 /* Get RGB color values. */
1806 color.pixel = *pixel;
1807 x_query_color (f, &color);
1809 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1810 xassert (factor >= 0);
1811 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1812 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1813 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1815 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1816 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1818 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1819 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1820 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1821 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1822 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1824 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1825 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1826 /* The additive adjustment. */
1827 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1829 if (factor < 1)
1831 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1832 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1833 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1835 else
1837 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1838 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1839 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1843 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1844 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1845 if (success_p)
1847 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1849 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1850 delta to the RGB values. */
1851 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1853 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1854 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1855 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1856 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1858 else
1859 success_p = 1;
1860 *pixel = new.pixel;
1863 return success_p;
1867 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1868 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1869 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1870 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1871 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1872 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1874 static void
1875 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1876 struct frame *f;
1877 struct relief *relief;
1878 double factor;
1879 int delta;
1880 unsigned long default_pixel;
1882 XGCValues xgcv;
1883 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1884 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1885 unsigned long pixel;
1886 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1887 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1888 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1889 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1891 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1892 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1894 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1895 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1896 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1897 if (relief->gc
1898 && relief->allocated_p)
1900 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1901 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1904 /* Allocate new color. */
1905 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1906 pixel = background;
1907 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1908 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1910 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1911 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1914 if (relief->gc == 0)
1916 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1917 mask |= GCStipple;
1918 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1920 else
1921 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1925 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1927 static void
1928 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1929 struct glyph_string *s;
1931 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1932 unsigned long color;
1934 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1935 color = s->face->box_color;
1936 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1937 && s->img->pixmap
1938 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1939 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1940 else
1942 XGCValues xgcv;
1944 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1945 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1946 color = xgcv.background;
1949 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1950 || color != di->relief_background)
1952 di->relief_background = color;
1953 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1954 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1955 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1956 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1961 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1962 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1963 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1964 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1965 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1966 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1967 when drawing. */
1969 static void
1970 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
1971 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
1972 struct frame *f;
1973 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
1974 XRectangle *clip_rect;
1976 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1977 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1978 int i;
1979 GC gc;
1981 if (raised_p)
1982 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1983 else
1984 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1985 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1987 /* Top. */
1988 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1989 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1990 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
1991 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
1993 /* Left. */
1994 if (left_p)
1995 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1996 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1997 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
1999 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2000 if (raised_p)
2001 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2002 else
2003 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2004 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2006 /* Bottom. */
2007 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2008 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2009 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2010 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2012 /* Right. */
2013 if (right_p)
2014 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2015 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2016 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2018 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2022 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2023 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2024 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2025 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2026 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2027 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2029 static void
2030 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2031 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2032 struct glyph_string *s;
2033 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2034 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2036 XGCValues xgcv;
2038 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2039 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2040 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2042 /* Top. */
2043 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2044 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2046 /* Left. */
2047 if (left_p)
2048 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2049 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2051 /* Bottom. */
2052 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2053 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2055 /* Right. */
2056 if (right_p)
2057 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2058 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2060 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2061 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2065 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2067 static void
2068 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2069 struct glyph_string *s;
2071 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2072 int left_p, right_p;
2073 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2074 XRectangle clip_rect;
2076 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
2077 if (s->row->full_width_p
2078 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2080 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (s->w);
2081 if (s->area != RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
2082 || WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (s->w))
2083 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->w);
2086 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2087 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2088 ? s->first_glyph
2089 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2091 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2092 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2093 left_x = s->x;
2094 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2095 ? last_x - 1
2096 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2097 top_y = s->y;
2098 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2100 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2101 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2102 && (s->prev == NULL
2103 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2104 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2105 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2106 && (s->next == NULL
2107 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2109 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2111 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2112 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2113 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2114 else
2116 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2117 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2118 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2123 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2125 static void
2126 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2127 struct glyph_string *s;
2129 int x;
2130 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2132 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2133 right of that line. */
2134 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2135 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2136 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2137 else
2138 x = s->x;
2140 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2141 by that margin. */
2142 x += s->img->hmargin;
2143 y += s->img->vmargin;
2145 if (s->img->pixmap)
2147 if (s->img->mask)
2149 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2150 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2151 trust on the shape extension to be available
2152 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2153 manually. */
2154 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2155 | GCFunction);
2156 XGCValues xgcv;
2157 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2159 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2160 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2161 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2162 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2163 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2165 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2166 image_rect.x = x;
2167 image_rect.y = y;
2168 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2169 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2170 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2171 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2172 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2174 else
2176 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2178 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2179 image_rect.x = x;
2180 image_rect.y = y;
2181 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2182 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2183 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2184 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2185 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2187 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2188 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2189 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2190 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2191 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2192 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2193 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2195 int r = s->img->relief;
2196 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2197 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2198 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2202 else
2203 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2204 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2205 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2209 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2211 static void
2212 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2213 struct glyph_string *s;
2215 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2216 XRectangle r;
2217 int x;
2218 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2220 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2221 right of that line. */
2222 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2223 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2224 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2225 else
2226 x = s->x;
2228 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2229 by that margin. */
2230 x += s->img->hmargin;
2231 y += s->img->vmargin;
2233 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2234 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2236 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2237 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2239 else
2241 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2242 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2245 x0 = x - thick;
2246 y0 = y - thick;
2247 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
2248 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
2250 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2251 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2252 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
2256 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2258 static void
2259 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2260 struct glyph_string *s;
2261 Pixmap pixmap;
2263 int x;
2264 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2266 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2267 right of that line. */
2268 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2269 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2270 x = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2271 else
2272 x = 0;
2274 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2275 by that margin. */
2276 x += s->img->hmargin;
2277 y += s->img->vmargin;
2279 if (s->img->pixmap)
2281 if (s->img->mask)
2283 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2284 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2285 trust on the shape extension to be available
2286 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2287 manually. */
2288 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2289 | GCFunction);
2290 XGCValues xgcv;
2292 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2293 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2294 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2295 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2296 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2298 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2299 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2300 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2302 else
2304 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2305 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2307 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2308 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2309 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2310 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2311 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2312 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2313 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2315 int r = s->img->relief;
2316 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2317 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2318 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2322 else
2323 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2324 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2325 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2329 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2330 give the rectangle to draw. */
2332 static void
2333 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2334 struct glyph_string *s;
2335 int x, y, w, h;
2337 if (s->stippled_p)
2339 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2340 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2341 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2342 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2344 else
2345 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2349 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2351 s->y
2352 s->x +-------------------------
2353 | s->face->box
2355 | +-------------------------
2356 | | s->img->margin
2358 | | +-------------------
2359 | | | the image
2363 static void
2364 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2365 struct glyph_string *s;
2367 int x, y;
2368 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2369 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2370 int height;
2371 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2373 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_vwidth;
2376 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2377 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2378 flickering. */
2379 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2380 if (height > s->img->height
2381 || s->img->hmargin
2382 || s->img->vmargin
2383 || s->img->mask
2384 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2385 || s->width != s->background_width)
2387 if (box_line_hwidth && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2388 x = s->x + box_line_hwidth;
2389 else
2390 x = s->x;
2392 y = s->y + box_line_vwidth;
2394 if (s->img->mask)
2396 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2397 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2398 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2399 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2400 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2402 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2403 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2404 s->background_width,
2405 s->height, depth);
2407 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2408 pixmap. */
2409 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2411 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2412 if (s->stippled_p)
2414 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2415 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2416 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2417 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2418 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2420 else
2422 XGCValues xgcv;
2423 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2424 &xgcv);
2425 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2426 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2427 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2428 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2431 else
2432 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2434 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2437 /* Draw the foreground. */
2438 if (pixmap != None)
2440 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2441 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2442 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2443 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2444 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2446 else
2447 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2449 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2450 if (s->img->relief
2451 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2452 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2453 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2457 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2459 static void
2460 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2461 struct glyph_string *s;
2463 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2464 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2466 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2467 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2469 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2470 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2471 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2473 /* Draw cursor. */
2474 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2476 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2477 if (width < s->background_width)
2479 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2480 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2481 XRectangle r;
2482 GC gc;
2484 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2485 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2487 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2488 gc = s->gc;
2490 else
2491 gc = s->face->gc;
2493 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2494 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2496 if (s->face->stipple)
2498 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2499 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2500 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2501 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2503 else
2505 XGCValues xgcv;
2506 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2507 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2508 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2509 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2513 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2514 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2515 s->height);
2517 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2521 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2523 static void
2524 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2525 struct glyph_string *s;
2527 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2529 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2530 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2531 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2532 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2534 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2535 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2536 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2537 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2540 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2541 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2543 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2544 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2545 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2546 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2547 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2548 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2551 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2552 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2553 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2554 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2555 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2557 else
2558 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2560 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2562 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2563 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2564 break;
2566 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2567 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2568 break;
2570 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2571 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2572 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2573 else
2574 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2575 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2576 break;
2578 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2579 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2580 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2581 else
2582 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2583 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2584 break;
2586 default:
2587 abort ();
2590 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2592 /* Draw underline. */
2593 if (s->face->underline_p)
2595 unsigned long tem, h;
2596 int y;
2598 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2599 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2600 h = 1;
2602 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2603 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2604 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2605 specs, and its default is
2607 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2608 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2610 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2611 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2612 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2613 else if (s->face->font)
2614 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2615 else
2616 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2618 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2619 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2620 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2621 else
2623 XGCValues xgcv;
2624 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2625 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2626 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2627 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2628 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2632 /* Draw overline. */
2633 if (s->face->overline_p)
2635 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2637 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2638 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2639 s->width, h);
2640 else
2642 XGCValues xgcv;
2643 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2644 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2645 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2646 s->width, h);
2647 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2651 /* Draw strike-through. */
2652 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2654 unsigned long h = 1;
2655 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2657 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2658 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2659 s->width, h);
2660 else
2662 XGCValues xgcv;
2663 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2664 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2665 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2666 s->width, h);
2667 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2671 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2672 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2673 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2676 /* Reset clipping. */
2677 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2680 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2682 void
2683 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2684 struct frame *f;
2685 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2687 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2688 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2689 x, y, width, height,
2690 x + shift_by, y);
2693 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2694 for X frames. */
2696 static void
2697 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2698 register int n;
2700 abort ();
2704 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2705 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2707 void
2708 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2709 Display *dpy;
2710 Window window;
2711 int x, y;
2712 int width, height;
2713 int exposures;
2715 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2716 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2720 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2721 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2723 static void
2724 x_clear_frame ()
2726 struct frame *f;
2728 if (updating_frame)
2729 f = updating_frame;
2730 else
2731 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2733 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2734 longer visible. */
2735 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2736 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2737 output_cursor.x = -1;
2739 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2740 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2741 BLOCK_INPUT;
2742 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2744 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2745 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2746 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2748 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2750 #ifdef USE_GTK
2751 xg_frame_cleared (f);
2752 #endif
2754 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2759 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2761 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2762 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2764 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2767 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2768 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2770 static int
2771 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2772 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2774 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2775 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2776 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2778 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2779 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2780 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2783 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2785 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2786 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2787 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2790 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2791 positive. */
2792 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2793 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2795 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2796 negative. */
2797 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2800 void
2801 XTflash (f)
2802 struct frame *f;
2804 BLOCK_INPUT;
2807 GC gc;
2809 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2810 pixels into background pixels. */
2812 XGCValues values;
2814 values.function = GXxor;
2815 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2816 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2818 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2819 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2823 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2824 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2825 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2826 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2827 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2828 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2829 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2831 int width;
2833 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2834 edge it is next to. */
2835 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2837 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2838 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2839 break;
2841 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2842 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2843 break;
2845 default:
2846 break;
2849 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2851 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2852 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2854 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2855 flash_left,
2856 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2857 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2858 width, flash_height);
2859 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2860 flash_left,
2861 (height - flash_height
2862 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2863 width, flash_height);
2865 else
2866 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2867 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2868 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2869 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2871 x_flush (f);
2874 struct timeval wakeup;
2876 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2878 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2879 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2880 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2881 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2883 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2884 available. */
2885 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2887 struct timeval current;
2888 struct timeval timeout;
2890 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2892 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2893 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2894 break;
2896 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2897 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2898 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2900 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2901 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2905 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2906 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2908 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2909 flash_left,
2910 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2911 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2912 width, flash_height);
2913 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2914 flash_left,
2915 (height - flash_height
2916 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2917 width, flash_height);
2919 else
2920 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2921 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2922 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2923 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2925 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2926 x_flush (f);
2930 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2933 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
2936 /* Make audible bell. */
2938 void
2939 XTring_bell ()
2941 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2943 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
2945 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2946 if (visible_bell)
2947 XTflash (f);
2948 else
2949 #endif
2951 BLOCK_INPUT;
2952 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
2953 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2954 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2960 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
2961 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
2962 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
2963 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
2965 static void
2966 XTset_terminal_window (n)
2967 register int n;
2969 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
2974 /***********************************************************************
2975 Line Dance
2976 ***********************************************************************/
2978 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
2979 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
2981 static void
2982 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
2983 int vpos, n;
2985 abort ();
2989 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
2991 static void
2992 x_scroll_run (w, run)
2993 struct window *w;
2994 struct run *run;
2996 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2997 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
2999 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3000 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3001 fringe of W. */
3002 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3004 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3005 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3006 bottom_y = y + height;
3008 if (to_y < from_y)
3010 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3011 line at the bottom. */
3012 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3013 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3014 else
3015 height = run->height;
3017 else
3019 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3020 at the bottom. */
3021 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3022 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3023 else
3024 height = run->height;
3027 BLOCK_INPUT;
3029 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3030 updated_window = w;
3031 x_clear_cursor (w);
3033 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3034 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3035 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3036 x, from_y,
3037 width, height,
3038 x, to_y);
3040 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3045 /***********************************************************************
3046 Exposure Events
3047 ***********************************************************************/
3050 static void
3051 frame_highlight (f)
3052 struct frame *f;
3054 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3055 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3056 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3057 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3058 BLOCK_INPUT;
3059 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3060 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3061 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3062 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3065 static void
3066 frame_unhighlight (f)
3067 struct frame *f;
3069 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3070 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3071 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3072 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3073 BLOCK_INPUT;
3074 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3075 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3076 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3077 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3080 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3081 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3082 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3083 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3084 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3086 static void
3087 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3088 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3089 struct frame *frame;
3091 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3093 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3095 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3096 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3097 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3099 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3100 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3102 #if 0
3103 selected_frame = frame;
3104 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3105 selected_frame);
3106 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3107 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3108 #endif /* ! 0 */
3110 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3111 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3112 else
3113 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3116 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3119 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3120 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3121 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into BUFP.
3122 Returns number of events inserted into BUFP. */
3124 static int
3125 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp, numchars)
3126 int type;
3127 int state;
3128 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3129 struct frame *frame;
3130 struct input_event *bufp;
3131 int numchars;
3133 int nr_events = 0;
3135 if (type == FocusIn)
3137 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3139 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3140 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3142 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3143 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3144 if (numchars > 0
3145 && GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3146 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3147 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3149 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3150 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3151 bufp->arg = Qnil;
3152 ++bufp;
3153 numchars--;
3154 ++nr_events;
3158 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3160 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3161 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3162 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3163 #endif
3165 else if (type == FocusOut)
3167 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3169 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3171 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3172 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3175 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3176 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3177 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3178 #endif
3181 return nr_events;
3184 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3185 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3187 Returns number of events inserted into BUFP. */
3189 static int
3190 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp, numchars)
3191 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3192 XEvent *event;
3193 struct input_event *bufp;
3194 int numchars;
3196 struct frame *frame;
3197 int nr_events = 0;
3199 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3200 if (! frame) return nr_events;
3202 switch (event->type)
3204 case EnterNotify:
3205 case LeaveNotify:
3206 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3207 && event->xcrossing.focus
3208 && ! (frame->output_data.x->focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3209 nr_events = x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify
3210 ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3211 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3212 dpyinfo,
3213 frame,
3214 bufp,
3215 numchars);
3216 break;
3218 case FocusIn:
3219 case FocusOut:
3220 nr_events = x_focus_changed (event->type,
3221 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer
3222 ? FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3223 dpyinfo,
3224 frame,
3225 bufp,
3226 numchars);
3227 break;
3230 return nr_events;
3234 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3236 void
3237 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3238 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3240 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3243 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3244 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3245 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3247 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3248 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3249 the appropriate X display info. */
3251 static void
3252 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3253 struct frame *frame;
3255 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3258 static void
3259 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3260 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3262 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3264 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3266 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3267 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3268 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3269 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3270 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3272 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3273 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3276 else
3277 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3279 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3281 if (old_highlight)
3282 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3283 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3284 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3290 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3292 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3293 static void
3294 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3295 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3297 int min_code, max_code;
3298 KeySym *syms;
3299 int syms_per_code;
3300 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3302 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3303 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3304 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3305 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3306 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3308 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3309 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3310 #else
3311 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3312 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3313 #endif
3315 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3316 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3317 &syms_per_code);
3318 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3320 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3321 Alt keysyms are on. */
3323 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3325 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3326 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3328 KeyCode code
3329 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3331 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3332 if (code == 0)
3333 continue;
3335 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3337 int code_col;
3339 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3341 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3343 switch (sym)
3345 case XK_Meta_L:
3346 case XK_Meta_R:
3347 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3348 break;
3350 case XK_Alt_L:
3351 case XK_Alt_R:
3352 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3353 break;
3355 case XK_Hyper_L:
3356 case XK_Hyper_R:
3357 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3358 break;
3360 case XK_Super_L:
3361 case XK_Super_R:
3362 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3363 break;
3365 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3366 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3367 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
3368 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3369 break;
3376 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3377 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3379 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3380 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3383 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3384 make them just meta, not alt. */
3385 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3387 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3390 XFree ((char *) syms);
3391 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3394 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3395 Emacs uses. */
3397 static unsigned int
3398 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3399 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3400 unsigned int state;
3402 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3403 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3404 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3405 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3406 Lisp_Object tem;
3408 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3409 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3410 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3411 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3412 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3413 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3414 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3415 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3418 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3419 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3420 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3421 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3422 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3423 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3426 static unsigned int
3427 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3428 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3429 unsigned int state;
3431 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3432 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3433 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3434 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3436 Lisp_Object tem;
3438 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3439 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3440 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3441 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3442 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3443 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3444 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3445 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3448 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3449 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3450 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3451 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3452 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3453 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3456 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3458 char *
3459 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3460 KeySym keysym;
3462 char *value;
3464 BLOCK_INPUT;
3465 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3466 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3468 return value;
3473 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3475 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3477 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3478 the mouse. */
3480 static Lisp_Object
3481 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3482 struct input_event *result;
3483 XButtonEvent *event;
3484 struct frame *f;
3486 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3487 otherwise. */
3488 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3489 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3490 result->timestamp = event->time;
3491 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3492 event->state)
3493 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3494 ? up_modifier
3495 : down_modifier));
3497 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3498 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3499 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3500 result->arg = Qnil;
3501 return Qnil;
3505 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3506 The input handler calls this.
3508 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3509 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3510 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3511 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3513 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3514 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3516 static void
3517 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3518 FRAME_PTR frame;
3519 XMotionEvent *event;
3521 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3522 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3523 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3525 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3527 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3528 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3529 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3532 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3533 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3534 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3535 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3536 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3538 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3539 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3540 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3545 /************************************************************************
3546 Mouse Face
3547 ************************************************************************/
3549 static void
3550 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3552 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3553 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3554 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3555 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3556 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3560 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3563 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3564 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3565 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3566 values. */
3568 static int
3569 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3570 struct frame *f;
3571 int x, y;
3572 XRectangle *rect;
3574 Lisp_Object window;
3575 int found = 0;
3577 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3578 if (!NILP (window))
3580 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
3581 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3582 struct glyph_row *end = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3584 for (; !found && r < end && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3585 if (r->y >= y)
3587 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3588 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3589 int gx;
3591 for (gx = r->x; !found && g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
3592 if (gx >= x)
3594 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3595 rect->height = r->height;
3596 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3597 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3598 found = 1;
3603 return found;
3607 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3608 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3610 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3611 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3612 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3613 position on the scroll bar.
3615 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3616 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3617 the mouse is over.
3619 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3620 was at this position.
3622 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3624 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3625 movement. */
3627 static void
3628 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3629 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3630 int insist;
3631 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3632 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3633 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3634 unsigned long *time;
3636 FRAME_PTR f1;
3638 BLOCK_INPUT;
3640 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3641 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3642 else
3644 Window root;
3645 int root_x, root_y;
3647 Window dummy_window;
3648 int dummy;
3650 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3652 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3653 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3654 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3655 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3657 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3659 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3660 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3661 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3663 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3664 &root,
3666 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3667 a different screen. */
3668 &dummy_window,
3670 /* The position on that root window. */
3671 &root_x, &root_y,
3673 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3674 &dummy, &dummy,
3676 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3677 we don't care. */
3678 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3680 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3681 containing the pointer. */
3683 Window win, child;
3684 int win_x, win_y;
3685 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3686 int count;
3688 win = root;
3690 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3691 structure is changing at the same time this function
3692 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3694 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3696 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3697 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3699 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3700 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3701 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3703 /* From-window, to-window. */
3704 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3706 /* From-position, to-position. */
3707 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3709 /* Child of win. */
3710 &child);
3711 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3713 else
3715 while (1)
3717 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3719 /* From-window, to-window. */
3720 root, win,
3722 /* From-position, to-position. */
3723 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3725 /* Child of win. */
3726 &child);
3728 if (child == None || child == win)
3729 break;
3731 win = child;
3732 parent_x = win_x;
3733 parent_y = win_y;
3736 /* Now we know that:
3737 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3738 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3739 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3740 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3741 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3742 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3743 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3744 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3745 never use them in that case.) */
3747 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3748 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3750 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3751 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3752 on the frame. */
3753 if (f1 != NULL
3754 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3755 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3756 f1 = NULL;
3757 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3760 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3761 f1 = 0;
3763 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3765 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3766 if (! f1)
3768 struct scroll_bar *bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (win);
3770 if (bar)
3772 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3773 win_x = parent_x;
3774 win_y = parent_y;
3778 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3779 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3781 if (f1)
3783 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3784 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3785 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3786 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3787 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3788 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3789 the frame are divided into. */
3791 int width, height, gx, gy;
3792 XRectangle rect;
3794 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3795 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3796 else
3798 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3799 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3800 gx = win_x;
3801 gy = win_y;
3803 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3804 round down even for negative values. */
3805 if (gx < 0)
3806 gx -= width - 1;
3807 if (gy < 0)
3808 gy -= height - 1;
3809 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3810 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3812 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3813 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3814 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3815 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3818 *bar_window = Qnil;
3819 *part = 0;
3820 *fp = f1;
3821 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3822 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3823 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3828 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3833 /***********************************************************************
3834 Scroll bars
3835 ***********************************************************************/
3837 /* Scroll bar support. */
3839 /* Given an X window ID, find the struct scroll_bar which manages it.
3840 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3841 bits. */
3843 static struct scroll_bar *
3844 x_window_to_scroll_bar (window_id)
3845 Window window_id;
3847 Lisp_Object tail;
3849 #ifdef USE_GTK
3850 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (window_id);
3851 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3853 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3854 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3855 tail = XCDR (tail))
3857 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3859 frame = XCAR (tail);
3860 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3861 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3862 abort ();
3864 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3865 right window ID. */
3866 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3867 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3868 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3869 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3870 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3871 condemned = Qnil,
3872 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3873 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3874 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id)
3875 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3878 return 0;
3882 #if defined USE_LUCID
3884 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3885 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3887 static Widget
3888 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3889 Window window;
3891 Lisp_Object tail;
3893 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3894 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3895 tail = XCDR (tail))
3897 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3898 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3900 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3901 return menu_bar;
3904 return NULL;
3907 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3910 /************************************************************************
3911 Toolkit scroll bars
3912 ************************************************************************/
3914 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3916 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3917 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3918 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3919 struct scroll_bar *));
3920 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3921 int, int, int));
3924 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3925 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3927 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3929 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3931 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3933 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3934 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3936 #ifndef USE_GTK
3937 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3939 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3941 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3943 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3944 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3945 to avoid jerkyness. */
3947 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3949 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
3951 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3952 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3953 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3954 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3956 static void
3957 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3958 num_params)
3959 Widget widget;
3960 XtPointer client_data;
3961 String action_name;
3962 XEvent *event;
3963 String *params;
3964 Cardinal *num_params;
3966 int scroll_bar_p;
3967 char *end_action;
3969 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
3970 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
3971 end_action = "Release";
3972 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
3973 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
3974 end_action = "EndScroll";
3975 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
3977 if (scroll_bar_p
3978 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
3979 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
3981 struct window *w;
3983 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
3984 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
3985 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
3987 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
3989 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
3990 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
3991 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
3993 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
3994 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
3996 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
3997 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4000 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4002 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4003 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4005 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4006 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4009 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4010 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4011 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4012 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4014 static void
4015 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4016 Lisp_Object window;
4017 int part, portion, whole;
4019 XEvent event;
4020 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4021 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4022 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4023 int i;
4025 BLOCK_INPUT;
4027 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4028 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4029 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4030 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4031 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4032 ev->format = 32;
4034 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4035 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4036 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4037 into that array in the event. */
4038 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4039 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4040 break;
4042 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4044 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4045 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4046 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4048 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4049 nbytes);
4050 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4051 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4054 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4055 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4056 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4057 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4058 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4059 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4061 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4062 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4064 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4065 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4066 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4067 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4068 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4072 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4073 in *IEVENT. */
4075 static void
4076 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4077 XEvent *event;
4078 struct input_event *ievent;
4080 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4081 Lisp_Object window;
4082 struct frame *f;
4083 struct window *w;
4085 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4086 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4088 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4089 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4091 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4092 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4093 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4094 #ifdef USE_GTK
4095 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4096 #else
4097 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4098 #endif
4099 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4100 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4101 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4102 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4103 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4107 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4109 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4111 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4114 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4115 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4116 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4118 static void
4119 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4120 Widget widget;
4121 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4123 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4124 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4125 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4127 switch (cs->reason)
4129 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4130 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4131 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4132 break;
4134 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4135 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4136 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4137 break;
4139 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4140 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4141 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4142 break;
4144 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4145 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4146 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4147 break;
4149 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4150 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4151 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4152 break;
4154 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4155 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4156 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4157 break;
4159 case XmCR_DRAG:
4161 int slider_size;
4163 /* Get the slider size. */
4164 BLOCK_INPUT;
4165 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4166 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4168 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4169 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4170 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4171 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4173 break;
4175 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4176 break;
4179 if (part >= 0)
4181 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4182 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4183 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4188 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4189 #ifdef USE_GTK
4190 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4191 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4193 static void
4194 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4195 GtkRange *widget;
4196 gpointer data;
4198 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4199 gdouble previous;
4200 gdouble position;
4201 gdouble *p;
4202 int diff;
4204 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4205 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4207 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4209 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4211 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4212 if (! p)
4214 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4215 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4216 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4219 previous = *p;
4220 *p = position;
4222 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4224 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4226 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4227 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4229 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4231 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4232 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4234 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4236 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4237 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4239 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4241 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4242 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4244 else
4246 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4247 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4248 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4249 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4252 if (part >= 0)
4254 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4255 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4256 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4260 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4262 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4263 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4264 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4265 the thumb is. */
4267 static void
4268 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4269 Widget widget;
4270 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4272 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4273 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4274 float shown;
4275 int whole, portion, height;
4276 int part;
4278 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4279 BLOCK_INPUT;
4280 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4281 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4283 whole = 10000000;
4284 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4286 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4287 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4288 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4289 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4290 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4291 bottom). */
4292 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4293 else
4294 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4296 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4297 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4298 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4299 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4303 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4304 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4305 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4306 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4307 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4308 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4309 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4311 static void
4312 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4313 Widget widget;
4314 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4316 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4317 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4318 int position = (long) call_data;
4319 Dimension height;
4320 int part;
4322 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4323 BLOCK_INPUT;
4324 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4325 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4327 if (abs (position) >= height)
4328 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4330 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4331 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4332 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4333 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4334 else
4335 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4337 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4338 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4339 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4340 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4343 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4344 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4346 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4348 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4349 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4351 #ifdef USE_GTK
4352 static void
4353 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4354 struct frame *f;
4355 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4357 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4359 BLOCK_INPUT;
4360 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4361 scroll_bar_name);
4362 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4365 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4367 static void
4368 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4369 struct frame *f;
4370 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4372 Window xwindow;
4373 Widget widget;
4374 Arg av[20];
4375 int ac = 0;
4376 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4377 unsigned long pixel;
4379 BLOCK_INPUT;
4381 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4382 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4383 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4384 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4385 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4386 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4387 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4388 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4389 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4391 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4392 if (pixel != -1)
4394 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4395 ++ac;
4398 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4399 if (pixel != -1)
4401 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4402 ++ac;
4405 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4406 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4408 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4409 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4410 (XtPointer) bar);
4411 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4412 (XtPointer) bar);
4413 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4414 (XtPointer) bar);
4415 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4416 (XtPointer) bar);
4417 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4418 (XtPointer) bar);
4419 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4420 (XtPointer) bar);
4421 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4422 (XtPointer) bar);
4424 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4425 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4427 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4428 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4429 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4430 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4432 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4434 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4435 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4436 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4437 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4438 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4439 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4440 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4441 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4443 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4444 if (pixel != -1)
4446 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4447 ++ac;
4450 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4451 if (pixel != -1)
4453 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4454 ++ac;
4457 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4459 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4460 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4462 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4463 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4464 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4465 pixel = -1;
4466 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4468 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4470 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4471 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4472 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4473 pixel = -1;
4474 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4477 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4478 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4479 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4480 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4481 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4483 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4484 ++ac;
4486 else
4487 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4488 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4489 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4491 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4492 the shadows. */
4493 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4494 ++ac;
4496 /* Specify the colors. */
4497 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4498 if (pixel != -1)
4500 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
4501 ++ac;
4503 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4504 if (pixel != -1)
4506 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
4507 ++ac;
4511 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4512 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4515 char *initial = "";
4516 char *val = initial;
4517 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4518 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4519 if (val == initial)
4520 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4521 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4522 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
4523 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4527 /* Define callbacks. */
4528 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4529 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4530 (XtPointer) bar);
4532 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4533 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4535 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4537 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4538 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4539 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4540 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4542 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4543 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4544 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4545 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4547 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4549 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4552 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4553 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4555 #ifdef USE_GTK
4556 static void
4557 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4558 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4559 int portion, position, whole;
4561 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4564 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4565 static void
4566 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4567 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4568 int portion, position, whole;
4570 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4571 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4572 float top, shown;
4574 BLOCK_INPUT;
4576 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4578 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4579 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4580 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4581 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4582 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4583 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4584 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4585 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4586 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4587 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4588 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4589 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4590 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4591 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4592 whole += portion;
4594 if (whole <= 0)
4595 top = 0, shown = 1;
4596 else
4598 top = (float) position / whole;
4599 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4602 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4604 int size, value;
4606 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4607 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4608 value. */
4609 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4610 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4611 size = max (size, 1);
4613 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4614 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4615 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4617 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4619 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4621 if (whole == 0)
4622 top = 0, shown = 1;
4623 else
4625 top = (float) position / whole;
4626 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4630 float old_top, old_shown;
4631 Dimension height;
4632 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4633 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4634 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4635 XtNheight, &height,
4636 NULL);
4638 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4639 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4640 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4641 else
4642 top = old_top;
4643 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4644 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4646 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4647 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4648 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4649 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4651 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4652 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4653 else
4655 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4656 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
4657 int scroll_mode = 0;
4659 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
4660 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
4662 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
4663 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
4664 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
4665 if (scroll_mode == 2)
4666 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
4668 #endif
4669 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4670 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4671 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4673 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4675 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4676 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
4677 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
4678 #endif
4682 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4684 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4686 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4688 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4692 /************************************************************************
4693 Scroll bars, general
4694 ************************************************************************/
4696 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4697 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4698 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4699 scroll bar. */
4701 static struct scroll_bar *
4702 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4703 struct window *w;
4704 int top, left, width, height;
4706 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4707 struct scroll_bar *bar
4708 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4710 BLOCK_INPUT;
4712 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4713 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4714 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4716 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4717 unsigned long mask;
4718 Window window;
4720 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4721 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4722 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4724 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4725 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4726 | ExposureMask);
4727 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4729 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4731 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4732 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4733 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4734 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4735 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4736 left, top, width,
4737 window_box_height (w), False);
4739 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4740 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4741 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4742 top,
4743 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4744 height,
4745 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4747 CopyFromParent,
4748 CopyFromParent,
4749 CopyFromParent,
4750 /* Attributes. */
4751 mask, &a);
4752 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4754 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4756 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4757 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4758 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4759 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4760 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4761 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4762 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4763 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4765 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4766 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4767 bar->prev = Qnil;
4768 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4769 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4770 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4772 /* Map the window/widget. */
4773 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4775 #ifdef USE_GTK
4776 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4777 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4778 top,
4779 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4780 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4781 max (height, 1),
4782 left,
4783 width);
4784 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4785 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4786 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4787 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4788 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4789 top,
4790 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4791 max (height, 1), 0);
4792 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4793 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4795 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4796 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4797 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4799 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4800 return bar;
4804 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4806 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4807 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4808 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4809 events.)
4811 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4812 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4813 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4814 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4815 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4817 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4819 static void
4820 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4821 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4822 int start, end;
4823 int rebuild;
4825 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4826 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4827 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4828 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4830 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4831 if (! rebuild
4832 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4833 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4834 return;
4836 BLOCK_INPUT;
4839 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4840 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4841 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4843 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4844 the distance between start and end. */
4846 int length = end - start;
4848 if (start < 0)
4849 start = 0;
4850 else if (start > top_range)
4851 start = top_range;
4852 end = start + length;
4854 if (end < start)
4855 end = start;
4856 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4857 end = top_range;
4860 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4861 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4862 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4864 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4865 if (end > top_range)
4866 end = top_range;
4868 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4869 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4870 that many pixels tall. */
4871 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4873 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4874 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4875 if (0 < start)
4876 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4877 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4878 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4879 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4880 inside_width, start,
4881 False);
4883 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4884 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4885 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4886 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4888 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4889 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4890 /* x, y, width, height */
4891 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4892 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4893 inside_width, end - start);
4895 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4896 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4897 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4898 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4900 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4901 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4902 if (end < inside_height)
4903 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4904 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4905 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4906 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4907 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4908 False);
4912 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4915 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4917 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4918 nil. */
4920 static void
4921 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4922 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4924 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4925 BLOCK_INPUT;
4927 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4928 #ifdef USE_GTK
4929 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4930 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4931 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4932 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4933 #else
4934 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4935 #endif
4937 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4938 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4940 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4944 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4945 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4946 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4947 create one. */
4949 static void
4950 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4951 struct window *w;
4952 int portion, whole, position;
4954 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4955 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4956 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4957 int window_y, window_height;
4959 /* Get window dimensions. */
4960 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4961 top = window_y;
4962 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4963 height = window_height;
4965 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4966 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4968 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4969 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4970 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4971 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4972 else
4973 sb_width = width;
4975 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
4976 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4977 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4978 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
4979 else
4980 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
4981 #else
4982 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4983 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
4984 else
4985 sb_left = left;
4986 #endif
4988 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
4989 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
4991 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4993 BLOCK_INPUT;
4994 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4995 left, top, width, height, False);
4996 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4999 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5001 else
5003 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5004 unsigned int mask = 0;
5006 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5008 BLOCK_INPUT;
5010 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5011 mask |= CWX;
5012 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5013 mask |= CWY;
5014 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5015 mask |= CWWidth;
5016 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5017 mask |= CWHeight;
5019 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5021 #ifdef USE_GTK
5022 if (mask)
5023 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5024 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5025 top,
5026 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5027 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5028 max (height, 1),
5029 left,
5030 width);
5031 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5033 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5034 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5035 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5036 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5037 left, top, width, height, False);
5038 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5039 if (mask)
5040 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5041 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5042 top,
5043 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5044 max (height, 1), 0);
5046 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5047 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5049 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5050 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5051 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5053 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5054 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5055 height, False);
5056 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5057 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5058 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5059 height, False);
5062 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5063 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5064 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5065 example. */
5067 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5068 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5069 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5071 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5072 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5073 left + area_width - rest, top,
5074 rest, height, False);
5075 else
5076 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5077 left, top, rest, height, False);
5081 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5082 if (mask)
5084 XWindowChanges wc;
5086 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5087 wc.y = top;
5088 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5089 wc.height = height;
5090 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5091 mask, &wc);
5094 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5096 /* Remember new settings. */
5097 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5098 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5099 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5100 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5105 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5106 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5107 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5108 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5109 dragged. */
5110 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5112 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5114 if (whole == 0)
5115 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5116 else
5118 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5119 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5120 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5123 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5125 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5129 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5130 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5131 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5132 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5133 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5134 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5135 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5137 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5138 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5139 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5141 static void
5142 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5143 FRAME_PTR frame;
5145 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5146 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5148 Lisp_Object bar;
5149 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5150 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5151 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5152 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5153 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5154 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5155 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5160 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5161 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5163 static void
5164 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5165 struct window *window;
5167 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5168 struct frame *f;
5170 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5171 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5172 abort ();
5174 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5176 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5177 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5178 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5180 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5181 the lists. */
5182 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5183 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5184 return;
5185 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5186 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5187 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5188 else
5189 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5190 one or the other! */
5191 abort ();
5193 else
5194 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5196 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5197 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5199 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5200 bar->prev = Qnil;
5201 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5202 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5203 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5206 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5207 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5209 static void
5210 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5211 FRAME_PTR f;
5213 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5215 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5217 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5218 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5219 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5221 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5223 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5225 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5227 next = b->next;
5228 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5231 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5232 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5236 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5237 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5238 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5240 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5241 mark bits. */
5243 static void
5244 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5245 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5246 XEvent *event;
5248 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5249 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5250 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5251 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5253 BLOCK_INPUT;
5255 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5257 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5258 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5260 /* x, y, width, height */
5261 0, 0,
5262 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5263 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5265 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5268 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5270 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5271 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5273 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5274 mark bits. */
5277 static void
5278 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5279 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5280 XEvent *event;
5281 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5283 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5284 abort ();
5286 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5287 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5288 emacs_event->modifiers
5289 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5290 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5291 event->xbutton.state)
5292 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5293 ? up_modifier
5294 : down_modifier));
5295 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5296 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5297 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5299 #if 0
5300 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5301 int internal_height
5302 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5303 #endif
5304 int top_range
5305 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5306 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5308 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5309 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5311 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5312 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5313 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5314 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5315 else
5316 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5318 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5319 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5320 whether or not we're dragging. */
5321 #if 0
5322 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5323 holding it. */
5324 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5325 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5326 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5327 #endif
5329 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5330 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5331 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5332 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5334 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5335 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5337 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5338 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5340 #endif
5342 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5343 #if 0
5344 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5345 the handle. */
5346 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5347 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5348 else
5349 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5350 #else
5351 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5352 #endif
5354 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5358 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5360 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5362 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5363 mark bits. */
5365 static void
5366 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5367 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5368 XEvent *event;
5370 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5372 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5374 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5375 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5377 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5378 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5380 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5381 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5383 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5385 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5387 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5392 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5394 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5395 on the scroll bar. */
5397 static void
5398 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5399 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5400 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5401 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5402 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5403 unsigned long *time;
5405 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5406 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5407 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5408 int win_x, win_y;
5409 Window dummy_window;
5410 int dummy_coord;
5411 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5413 BLOCK_INPUT;
5415 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5416 report that. */
5417 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5419 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5420 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5421 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5423 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5424 &win_x, &win_y,
5426 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5427 &dummy_mask))
5429 else
5431 #if 0
5432 int inside_height
5433 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5434 #endif
5435 int top_range
5436 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5438 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5440 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5441 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5443 if (win_y < 0)
5444 win_y = 0;
5445 if (win_y > top_range)
5446 win_y = top_range;
5448 *fp = f;
5449 *bar_window = bar->window;
5451 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5452 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5453 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5454 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5455 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5456 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5457 else
5458 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5460 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5461 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5463 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5464 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5467 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5469 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5473 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5474 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5475 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5476 redraw them. */
5478 void
5479 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5480 FRAME_PTR f;
5482 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5483 Lisp_Object bar;
5485 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5486 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5487 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5488 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5489 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5490 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5491 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5492 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5493 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5494 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5498 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
5500 struct selection_event_queue
5502 XEvent event;
5503 struct selection_event_queue *next;
5506 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
5508 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
5510 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
5512 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
5514 static void
5515 x_queue_event (f, event)
5516 FRAME_PTR f;
5517 XEvent *event;
5519 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
5520 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
5522 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
5524 queue_tmp->event = *event;
5525 queue_tmp->next = queue;
5526 queue = queue_tmp;
5530 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
5531 so that they get processed afresh. */
5533 static void
5534 x_unqueue_events (display)
5535 Display *display;
5537 while (queue != NULL)
5539 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
5540 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
5541 queue = queue_tmp->next;
5542 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
5546 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5548 void
5549 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5550 Display *display;
5552 x_queue_selection_requests++;
5555 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5557 void
5558 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5559 Display *display;
5561 x_queue_selection_requests--;
5562 x_unqueue_events (display);
5565 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5567 #if 0
5568 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5569 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5570 sometimes don't work. */
5572 static Time enter_timestamp;
5573 #endif
5575 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5576 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5577 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5578 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5580 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5581 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5583 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5585 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5586 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5588 static int temp_index;
5589 static short temp_buffer[100];
5591 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5592 on a particular display. */
5594 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5596 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5597 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5598 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5599 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5601 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5603 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5604 do \
5606 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5607 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5608 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5609 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5610 if (numchars >= 1) \
5612 bufp->kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5613 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f); \
5614 bufp->arg = Qnil; \
5615 bufp++; \
5616 count++; \
5617 numchars--; \
5620 while (0)
5622 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5623 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5626 enum
5628 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5629 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5630 X_EVENT_DROP
5633 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5634 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5635 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5637 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5638 this event further.
5639 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5641 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5642 static int
5643 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5644 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5645 XEvent *event;
5647 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5648 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5649 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5650 was created. */
5652 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5653 event->xclient.window);
5655 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5657 #endif
5659 #ifdef USE_GTK
5660 static struct x_display_info *current_dpyinfo;
5661 static struct input_event **current_bufp;
5662 static int *current_numcharsp;
5663 static int current_count;
5664 static int current_finish;
5666 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5667 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5668 so we have a chanse to act on the event before GTK. */
5669 static GdkFilterReturn
5670 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5671 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5672 GdkEvent *ev;
5673 gpointer data;
5675 XEvent *xev = (XEvent*)gxev;
5677 if (current_numcharsp)
5679 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5680 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5681 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5682 so we do it here. */
5683 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5684 if (x_filter_event (current_dpyinfo, xev))
5685 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5686 #endif
5687 current_count += handle_one_xevent (current_dpyinfo,
5688 xev,
5689 current_bufp,
5690 current_numcharsp,
5691 &current_finish);
5693 else
5694 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, GDK_DISPLAY ());
5696 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5697 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5699 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5701 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5704 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5706 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5707 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5708 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5710 Events representing keys are stored in buffer *BUFP_R,
5711 which can hold up to *NUMCHARSP characters.
5712 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5714 static int
5715 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, bufp_r, numcharsp, finish)
5716 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5717 XEvent *eventp;
5718 /* register */ struct input_event **bufp_r;
5719 /* register */ int *numcharsp;
5720 int *finish;
5722 int count = 0;
5723 int nbytes = 0;
5724 struct frame *f;
5725 struct coding_system coding;
5726 struct input_event *bufp = *bufp_r;
5727 int numchars = *numcharsp;
5728 XEvent event = *eventp;
5730 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5732 switch (event.type)
5734 case ClientMessage:
5736 if (event.xclient.message_type
5737 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5738 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5740 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5741 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5743 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5744 could be the shell widget window
5745 if the frame has no title bar. */
5746 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5747 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5748 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5749 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5750 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5751 #endif
5752 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5753 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5754 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5755 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5756 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5757 needed.
5759 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5760 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5761 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5762 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5763 Emacs. */
5765 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5766 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5767 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5768 if (f)
5770 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5771 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5772 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5773 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5774 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5775 /* The ICCCM says this is
5776 the only valid choice. */
5777 RevertToParent,
5778 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5779 /* This is needed to detect the error
5780 if there is an error. */
5781 XSync (d, False);
5782 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5784 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5785 #endif /* 0 */
5787 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5788 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5790 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5791 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5792 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5793 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5794 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5795 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5796 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5797 session manager and one for this. */
5798 if (numchars > 0
5799 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5800 && ! x_session_have_connection ()
5801 #endif
5804 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5805 event.xclient.window);
5806 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5807 for a single Emacs process. */
5808 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5809 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5810 event.xclient.window,
5811 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5812 else if (f)
5813 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5814 event.xclient.window,
5815 0, 0);
5818 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5819 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5821 struct frame *f
5822 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5823 event.xclient.window);
5825 if (f)
5827 if (numchars == 0)
5828 abort ();
5830 bufp->kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5831 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
5832 bufp->arg = Qnil;
5833 bufp++;
5835 count += 1;
5836 numchars -= 1;
5838 else
5839 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5842 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5843 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5846 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5847 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5849 int new_x, new_y;
5850 struct frame *f
5851 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5853 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5854 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5856 if (f)
5858 f->left_pos = new_x;
5859 f->top_pos = new_y;
5862 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5863 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5864 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5866 struct frame *f
5867 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5868 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5869 &event, NULL);
5871 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5872 else if ((event.xclient.message_type
5873 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5874 || (event.xclient.message_type
5875 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5877 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5878 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5879 currently never do because we are interested in
5880 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5881 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5882 struct frame *f
5883 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5884 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5885 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5887 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5888 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5889 we construct an input_event. */
5890 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5891 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5893 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, bufp);
5894 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
5895 goto out;
5897 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5898 else
5899 goto OTHER;
5901 break;
5903 case SelectionNotify:
5904 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5905 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5906 goto OTHER;
5907 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5908 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5909 break;
5911 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5912 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5913 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5914 goto OTHER;
5915 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5917 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5919 if (numchars == 0)
5920 abort ();
5922 bufp->kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5923 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
5924 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
5925 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
5926 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
5927 bufp->arg = Qnil;
5928 bufp++;
5930 count += 1;
5931 numchars -= 1;
5933 break;
5935 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5936 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5937 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5938 goto OTHER;
5939 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5940 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
5941 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
5942 &event);
5943 else
5945 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5946 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5948 if (numchars == 0)
5949 abort ();
5951 bufp->kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5952 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
5953 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (bufp) = eventp->requestor;
5954 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
5955 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (bufp) = eventp->target;
5956 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (bufp) = eventp->property;
5957 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
5958 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
5959 bufp->arg = Qnil;
5960 bufp++;
5962 count += 1;
5963 numchars -= 1;
5965 break;
5967 case PropertyNotify:
5968 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5969 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5970 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5971 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5972 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5973 goto OTHER;
5974 #endif
5975 #endif
5976 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5977 goto OTHER;
5979 case ReparentNotify:
5980 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5981 if (f)
5983 int x, y;
5984 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5985 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5986 f->left_pos = x;
5987 f->top_pos = y;
5989 goto OTHER;
5990 break;
5992 case Expose:
5993 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5994 if (f)
5996 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5998 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6000 f->async_visible = 1;
6001 f->async_iconified = 0;
6002 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6003 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6005 else
6006 expose_frame (f,
6007 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6008 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6010 else
6012 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6013 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6014 #endif
6015 #if defined USE_LUCID
6016 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6017 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6018 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6020 Widget widget
6021 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6022 if (widget)
6023 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6025 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6027 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6028 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6029 goto OTHER;
6030 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6031 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6033 if (bar)
6034 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6035 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6036 else
6037 goto OTHER;
6038 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6039 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6041 break;
6043 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6044 source area was obscured or not
6045 available. */
6046 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6047 if (f)
6049 expose_frame (f,
6050 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6051 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6052 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6054 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6055 else
6056 goto OTHER;
6057 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6058 break;
6060 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6061 source area was completely
6062 available. */
6063 break;
6065 case UnmapNotify:
6066 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6067 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6069 tip_window = 0;
6070 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6073 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6074 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6075 the frame was deleted. */
6077 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6078 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6079 display that won't ever be seen. */
6080 f->async_visible = 0;
6081 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6082 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6083 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6084 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6085 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6086 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6087 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6089 f->async_iconified = 1;
6091 bufp->kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6092 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6093 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6094 bufp++;
6095 count++;
6096 numchars--;
6099 goto OTHER;
6101 case MapNotify:
6102 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6103 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6104 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6105 goto OTHER;
6107 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6108 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6109 frame is visible. */
6110 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6111 if (f)
6113 /* wait_reading_process_input will notice this and update
6114 the frame's display structures.
6115 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6116 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6117 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6118 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6119 if (! f->async_iconified)
6120 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6122 f->async_visible = 1;
6123 f->async_iconified = 0;
6124 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6126 if (f->iconified)
6128 bufp->kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6129 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6130 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6131 bufp++;
6132 count++;
6133 numchars--;
6135 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6136 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6137 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6138 to update the frame titles
6139 in case this is the second frame. */
6140 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6142 goto OTHER;
6144 case KeyPress:
6146 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6147 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6148 if (popup_activated ())
6149 goto OTHER;
6150 #endif
6152 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6154 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6156 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6157 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6160 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6161 if (f == 0)
6163 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6164 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6165 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6166 event.xkey.window);
6167 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6169 widget = XtParent (widget);
6170 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6173 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6175 if (f != 0)
6177 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6178 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6179 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6180 his Emacs hang.
6182 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6183 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6184 status_return even if the input is too long to
6185 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6186 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6187 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6188 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6189 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6190 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6191 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6192 int modifiers;
6193 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6195 event.xkey.state
6196 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6197 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6198 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6200 /* This will have to go some day... */
6202 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6203 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6204 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6205 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6206 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6207 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6208 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6210 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6211 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6212 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6213 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6214 not it is combined with Meta. */
6215 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6216 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6218 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6219 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6221 Status status_return;
6223 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6224 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6225 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6226 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6227 &status_return);
6228 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6230 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6231 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6232 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6233 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6234 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6235 &status_return);
6237 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6238 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6239 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6240 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6241 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6242 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6243 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6244 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6245 &status_return);
6246 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6248 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6249 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6250 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6251 &event.xkey,
6252 copy_bufptr,
6253 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6254 &status_return);
6257 #endif
6259 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6260 break;
6261 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6263 keysym = NoSymbol;
6264 modifiers = 0;
6266 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6267 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6268 abort ();
6270 else
6271 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6272 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6273 &compose_status);
6274 #else
6275 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6276 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6277 &compose_status);
6278 #endif
6280 orig_keysym = keysym;
6282 if (numchars > 1)
6284 Lisp_Object c;
6286 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6287 translations to characters. */
6288 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6289 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6291 bufp->kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6292 bufp->code = keysym;
6293 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6294 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6295 bufp->modifiers
6296 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6297 modifiers);
6298 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6299 bufp++;
6300 count++;
6301 numchars--;
6303 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6304 else if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6305 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6306 Vx_keysym_table,
6307 Qnil))))
6309 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6310 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6311 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6312 bufp->code = XFASTINT (c);
6313 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6314 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6315 bufp->modifiers
6316 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6317 modifiers);
6318 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6319 bufp++;
6320 count++;
6321 numchars--;
6323 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6324 else if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6325 || keysym == XK_Delete
6326 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6327 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6328 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6329 #endif
6330 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6331 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6332 #ifdef HPUX
6333 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6334 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6335 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6336 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6337 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6338 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6339 #endif
6340 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6341 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6342 #endif
6343 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6344 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6345 #endif
6346 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6347 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6348 #endif
6349 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6350 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6351 #endif
6352 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6353 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6354 #endif
6355 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6356 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6357 #endif
6358 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6359 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6360 #endif
6361 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6362 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6363 #endif
6364 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6365 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6366 #endif
6367 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6368 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6369 #endif
6370 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6371 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6372 #endif
6373 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6374 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6375 #endif
6376 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6377 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6378 #endif
6379 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6380 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6381 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6382 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6383 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6384 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6385 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6386 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6387 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6388 #endif
6389 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6390 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6391 #endif
6392 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6393 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6394 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6395 don't have real modifiers but
6396 should be treated similarly to
6397 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6398 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6399 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6400 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6401 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6402 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6403 #endif
6406 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short))
6407 temp_index = 0;
6408 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = keysym;
6409 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6410 key. */
6411 bufp->kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6412 bufp->code = keysym;
6413 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6414 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6415 bufp->modifiers
6416 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6417 modifiers);
6418 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6419 bufp++;
6420 count++;
6421 numchars--;
6423 else if (numchars > nbytes)
6424 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6425 register int i;
6426 register int c;
6427 int nchars, len;
6429 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6430 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6431 we used just above and the locale. */
6432 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6433 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6434 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6435 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6436 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6437 gives us composition information. */
6438 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6440 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6442 if (temp_index == (sizeof temp_buffer
6443 / sizeof (short)))
6444 temp_index = 0;
6445 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = copy_bufptr[i];
6449 /* Decode the input data. */
6450 int require;
6451 unsigned char *p;
6453 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6454 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6455 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6456 /* We explicitly disable composition
6457 handling because key data should
6458 not contain any composition
6459 sequence. */
6460 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6461 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p,
6462 nbytes, require);
6463 nbytes = coding.produced;
6464 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6465 copy_bufptr = p;
6468 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6469 character events. */
6470 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6472 if (nchars == nbytes)
6473 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6474 else
6475 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6476 nbytes - i, len);
6478 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6479 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6480 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6481 bufp->code = c;
6482 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6483 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6484 bufp->modifiers
6485 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6486 modifiers);
6487 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6488 bufp++;
6491 count += nchars;
6492 numchars -= nchars;
6494 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6495 break;
6497 else
6498 abort ();
6500 else
6501 abort ();
6503 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6504 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6505 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6506 client. */
6507 break;
6508 #else
6509 goto OTHER;
6510 #endif
6512 case KeyRelease:
6513 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6514 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6515 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6516 client. */
6517 break;
6518 #else
6519 goto OTHER;
6520 #endif
6522 case EnterNotify:
6524 int n;
6526 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6527 if (n > 0)
6529 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6532 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6534 #if 0
6535 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6537 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6538 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6539 || !(f->auto_lower)
6540 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6542 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6543 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6546 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6547 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6548 #endif
6550 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6551 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6552 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6553 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6554 goto OTHER;
6557 case FocusIn:
6559 int n;
6561 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6562 if (n > 0)
6564 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6568 goto OTHER;
6570 case LeaveNotify:
6572 int n;
6574 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6575 if (n > 0)
6577 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6581 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6582 if (f)
6584 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6586 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6587 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6588 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6592 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6593 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6594 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6595 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6596 if (any_help_event_p)
6598 Lisp_Object frame;
6599 int n;
6601 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6602 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6603 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars,
6604 Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6605 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6609 goto OTHER;
6611 case FocusOut:
6613 int n;
6615 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6616 if (n > 0)
6618 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6622 goto OTHER;
6624 case MotionNotify:
6626 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6627 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6628 help_echo_pos = -1;
6630 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6631 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6632 f = last_mouse_frame;
6633 else
6634 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6636 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6638 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6639 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6642 if (f)
6645 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6646 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6648 Lisp_Object window;
6650 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6651 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6652 0, 0, 0, 0);
6654 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6655 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6656 will be selected iff it is active. */
6657 if (WINDOWP(window)
6658 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6659 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6660 && numchars > 0)
6662 bufp->kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6663 bufp->frame_or_window = window;
6664 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6665 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
6668 last_window=window;
6670 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6672 else
6674 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6675 struct scroll_bar *bar
6676 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.window);
6678 if (bar)
6679 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6680 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6682 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6683 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6684 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6687 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6688 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6689 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6690 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6692 Lisp_Object frame;
6693 int n;
6695 if (f)
6696 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6697 else
6698 frame = Qnil;
6700 any_help_event_p = 1;
6701 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars, help_echo_string, frame,
6702 help_echo_window, help_echo_object,
6703 help_echo_pos);
6704 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6707 goto OTHER;
6710 case ConfigureNotify:
6711 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6712 if (f)
6714 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6715 #ifdef USE_GTK
6716 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6717 event.xconfigure.height);
6718 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6719 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6720 do this one, the right one will come later.
6721 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6722 need to reset it below. */
6723 int dont_resize
6724 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6725 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6726 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6727 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6729 if (dont_resize)
6730 goto OTHER;
6732 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6733 is called by the code that handles resizing
6734 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6736 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6737 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6738 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6739 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6740 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6741 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6742 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6744 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6745 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6746 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6748 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6749 #endif
6751 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6752 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6754 #ifdef USE_GTK
6755 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6756 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6757 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6758 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6759 #endif
6761 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6762 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6763 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6765 x_check_fullscreen_move (f);
6766 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6767 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6770 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6771 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6772 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6773 #endif
6775 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6777 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6778 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6779 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6780 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6783 goto OTHER;
6785 case ButtonRelease:
6786 case ButtonPress:
6788 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6789 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6790 struct input_event emacs_event;
6791 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6793 emacs_event.kind = NO_EVENT;
6794 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6796 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6797 && last_mouse_frame
6798 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6799 f = last_mouse_frame;
6800 else
6801 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6803 if (f)
6805 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6806 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6807 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6809 Lisp_Object window;
6810 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6811 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6813 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6814 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6816 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6817 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6818 else
6819 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6820 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6821 event.xbutton.state));
6822 tool_bar_p = 1;
6826 if (!tool_bar_p)
6827 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6828 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6830 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6831 if (! popup_activated ())
6832 #endif
6833 construct_mouse_click (&emacs_event, &event, f);
6836 else
6838 struct scroll_bar *bar
6839 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.window);
6841 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6842 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6843 scroll bars. */
6844 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6846 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
6847 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6849 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6850 if (bar)
6851 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
6852 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6855 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6857 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6858 last_mouse_frame = f;
6859 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
6860 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
6861 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
6862 the ButtonPress. */
6863 if (f != 0)
6864 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6866 if (!tool_bar_p)
6867 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6869 else
6870 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6872 if (numchars >= 1 && emacs_event.kind != NO_EVENT)
6874 bcopy (&emacs_event, bufp, sizeof (struct input_event));
6875 bufp++;
6876 count++;
6877 numchars--;
6880 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6881 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6882 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6883 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6884 Instead, save it away
6885 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6886 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6887 if (
6888 #ifdef USE_GTK
6889 ! popup_activated ()
6891 #endif
6892 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6893 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6894 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6895 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6896 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6897 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6898 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6899 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6901 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6902 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6903 #ifdef USE_GTK
6904 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6905 #endif
6907 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6909 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6910 goto OTHER;
6913 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6914 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6915 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6917 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6919 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6920 if (f->output_data.x)
6921 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6923 else
6924 goto OTHER;
6926 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6927 else
6928 goto OTHER;
6929 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6931 break;
6933 case CirculateNotify:
6934 goto OTHER;
6936 case CirculateRequest:
6937 goto OTHER;
6939 case VisibilityNotify:
6940 goto OTHER;
6942 case MappingNotify:
6943 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6944 local cache. */
6945 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6947 case MappingModifier:
6948 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6949 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6950 case MappingKeyboard:
6951 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6953 goto OTHER;
6955 default:
6956 OTHER:
6957 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6958 BLOCK_INPUT;
6959 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6960 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6961 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6962 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6963 break;
6966 goto ret;
6968 out:
6969 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6971 ret:
6972 *bufp_r = bufp;
6973 *numcharsp = numchars;
6974 *eventp = event;
6976 return count;
6980 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6981 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6982 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6984 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6986 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6987 XEvent *event;
6988 Display *display;
6990 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6991 struct input_event bufp[10];
6992 struct input_event *bufpp = bufp;
6993 int numchars = 10;
6994 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6996 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6997 if (dpyinfo->display == display)
6998 break;
7000 if (dpyinfo)
7002 int i, events;
7003 events = handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo,
7004 event,
7005 &bufpp,
7006 &numchars,
7007 &finish);
7008 for (i = 0; i < events; ++i)
7009 kbd_buffer_store_event (&bufp[i]);
7012 return finish;
7016 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7017 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7018 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7020 Events representing keys are stored in buffer BUFP,
7021 which can hold up to NUMCHARS characters.
7022 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7023 thus pretending to be `read'.
7025 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7027 static int
7028 XTread_socket (sd, bufp, numchars, expected)
7029 register int sd;
7030 /* register */ struct input_event *bufp;
7031 /* register */ int numchars;
7032 int expected;
7034 int count = 0;
7035 XEvent event;
7036 int event_found = 0;
7037 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7039 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7041 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7042 return -1;
7045 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7046 BLOCK_INPUT;
7048 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7049 input_signal_count++;
7051 if (numchars <= 0)
7052 abort (); /* Don't think this happens. */
7054 ++handling_signal;
7056 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7057 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7058 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7060 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7061 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
7062 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7063 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7064 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7065 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7066 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7067 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7068 #endif
7070 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7071 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7072 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7073 for X connections. */
7074 #ifndef SIGIO
7075 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7076 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7078 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7079 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7080 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7081 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7083 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7084 #endif /* SIGIO */
7085 #endif
7087 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7088 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7090 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7091 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7094 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7095 BLOCK_INPUT;
7096 count += x_session_check_input (bufp, &numchars);
7097 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7098 #endif
7100 #ifdef USE_GTK
7101 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7102 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7103 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7104 that is kind of ugly, but it works. */
7105 current_dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
7107 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7109 static int nr = 0;
7110 current_count = count;
7111 current_numcharsp = &numchars;
7112 current_bufp = &bufp;
7114 gtk_main_iteration ();
7116 count = current_count;
7117 current_bufp = 0;
7118 current_numcharsp = 0;
7120 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7121 goto out;
7124 #else /* not USE_GTK */
7125 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7127 int finish;
7129 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7131 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7132 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7133 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7134 break;
7135 #endif
7136 event_found = 1;
7138 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo,
7139 &event,
7140 &bufp,
7141 &numchars,
7142 &finish);
7144 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7145 goto out;
7147 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7150 out:;
7152 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7153 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7154 if (! event_found)
7156 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7157 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7158 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7159 x_noop_count++;
7160 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7162 x_noop_count=0;
7164 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7165 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7167 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7169 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7170 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7174 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7175 raise it now. */
7176 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7177 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7179 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7180 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7183 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7184 --handling_signal;
7185 return count;
7191 /***********************************************************************
7192 Text Cursor
7193 ***********************************************************************/
7195 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7196 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7198 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7199 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7200 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7202 static void
7203 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc)
7204 struct window *w;
7205 struct glyph_row *row;
7206 GC gc;
7208 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7209 XRectangle clip_rect;
7210 int window_y, window_width;
7212 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7214 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
7215 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
7216 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7217 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7218 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7220 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7224 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7226 static void
7227 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7228 struct window *w;
7229 struct glyph_row *row;
7231 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7232 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7233 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7234 int x, y, wd, h;
7235 XGCValues xgcv;
7236 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7237 GC gc;
7239 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
7240 coordinates. */
7241 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7242 y = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y)
7243 + row->ascent - w->phys_cursor_ascent);
7244 h = row->height - 1;
7246 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7247 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7248 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7249 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7250 return;
7252 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
7253 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
7254 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
7255 width instead. */
7256 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
7257 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
7258 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
7259 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
7260 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
7262 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7263 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7264 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7265 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7266 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7267 else
7268 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7269 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7270 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7272 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7273 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7274 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7275 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7279 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7281 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7282 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7283 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7284 --gerd. */
7286 static void
7287 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7288 struct window *w;
7289 struct glyph_row *row;
7290 int width;
7291 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7293 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7294 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7296 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7297 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7298 and mini-buffer. */
7299 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7300 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7301 return;
7303 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7304 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7305 the bar might not be in the window. */
7306 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7308 struct glyph_row *row;
7309 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7310 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7312 else
7314 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7315 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7316 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7317 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7318 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7319 XGCValues xgcv;
7321 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7322 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7323 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7324 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7325 that the glyph is legible. */
7326 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7327 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7328 else
7329 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7330 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7332 if (gc)
7333 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7334 else
7336 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7337 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7340 if (width < 0)
7341 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7342 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7344 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7345 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7347 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7348 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7349 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7350 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7351 width, row->height);
7352 else
7353 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7354 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7355 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7356 row->height - width),
7357 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7358 width);
7360 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7365 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7367 static void
7368 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7369 struct frame *f;
7370 Cursor cursor;
7372 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7376 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7378 static void
7379 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7380 struct frame *f;
7381 int x, y, width, height;
7383 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7384 x, y, width, height, False);
7388 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7390 static void
7391 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7392 struct window *w;
7393 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7394 int x, y;
7395 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7396 int on_p, active_p;
7398 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7400 if (on_p)
7402 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7403 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7405 switch (cursor_type)
7407 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7408 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7409 break;
7411 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7412 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7413 break;
7415 case BAR_CURSOR:
7416 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7417 break;
7419 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7420 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7421 break;
7423 case NO_CURSOR:
7424 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7425 break;
7427 default:
7428 abort ();
7431 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7432 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7433 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7434 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7435 #endif
7438 #ifndef XFlush
7439 if (updating_frame != f)
7440 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7441 #endif
7445 /* Icons. */
7447 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7450 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7451 struct frame *f;
7452 Lisp_Object file;
7454 int bitmap_id;
7456 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7457 return 1;
7459 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap if any. */
7460 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7461 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7462 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7464 if (STRINGP (file))
7465 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7466 else
7468 /* Create the GNU bitmap if necessary. */
7469 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7470 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7471 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7472 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7474 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap,
7475 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7476 As a result, the GNU bitmap is never freed.
7477 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7478 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7480 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7483 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7484 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7486 return 0;
7490 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7491 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7494 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7495 struct frame *f;
7496 char *icon_name;
7498 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7499 return 1;
7501 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7503 XTextProperty text;
7504 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7505 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7506 text.format = 8;
7507 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7508 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7510 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7511 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7512 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7514 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7515 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7516 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7517 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7519 return 0;
7522 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7524 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7525 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7527 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7529 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7530 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7531 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7533 static void
7534 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7535 Display *display;
7536 XErrorEvent *error;
7538 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7539 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7540 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7543 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7544 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7545 operating on.
7547 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7548 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7549 stored in x_error_message_string.
7551 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7552 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7554 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7556 void x_check_errors ();
7557 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7560 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7561 Display *dpy;
7563 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7565 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7566 XSync (dpy, False);
7568 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7569 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7570 x_error_message_string));
7572 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7573 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7575 return count;
7578 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7580 static Lisp_Object
7581 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7582 Lisp_Object old_val;
7584 Lisp_Object first;
7586 first = XCAR (old_val);
7588 XSync (XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer, False);
7590 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7591 return Qnil;
7594 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7595 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7596 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7598 void
7599 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7600 Display *dpy;
7601 char *format;
7603 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7604 XSync (dpy, False);
7606 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7607 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7610 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7611 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7614 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7615 Display *dpy;
7617 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7618 XSync (dpy, False);
7620 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7623 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7625 void
7626 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7627 Display *dpy;
7629 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7632 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7633 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7634 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7635 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7637 void
7638 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7639 Display *dpy;
7640 int count;
7642 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7645 #if 0
7646 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7647 x_trace_wire ()
7649 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7651 #endif /* ! 0 */
7654 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7655 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7656 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7657 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7658 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7660 static SIGTYPE
7661 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7662 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7664 #ifdef USG
7665 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7666 must reestablish each time */
7667 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7668 #endif /* USG */
7672 /************************************************************************
7673 Handling X errors
7674 ************************************************************************/
7676 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7678 static char *error_msg;
7680 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7681 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7682 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7684 static void
7685 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7687 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7688 exit (70);
7691 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7692 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7694 static SIGTYPE
7695 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7696 Display *dpy;
7697 char *error_message;
7699 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7700 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7701 int count;
7703 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7704 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7705 handling_signal = 0;
7707 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7708 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7709 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7710 the original message here. */
7711 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7713 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7714 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7715 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7717 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7718 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7719 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7721 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7722 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7724 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7725 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7726 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7728 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7729 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7730 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7731 if (dpyinfo)
7733 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7734 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7735 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7736 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7738 #endif
7740 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7741 if (dpyinfo)
7742 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7744 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7745 that are on the dead display. */
7746 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7748 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7749 minibuf_frame
7750 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7751 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7752 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7753 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7754 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7755 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7758 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7759 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7760 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7761 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7762 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7763 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7765 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7766 trying to find a replacement. */
7767 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7768 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7771 if (dpyinfo)
7772 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7774 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7776 if (x_display_list == 0)
7778 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7779 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7780 exit (70);
7783 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7784 #ifdef SIGIO
7785 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7786 #endif
7787 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7788 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7790 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7791 error ("%s", error_msg);
7795 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7796 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7797 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7799 static void
7800 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7801 Display *display;
7802 XErrorEvent *error;
7804 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7806 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7807 original error handler. */
7809 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7810 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7811 buf, error->request_code);
7812 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7816 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7817 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7819 static int
7820 x_error_handler (display, error)
7821 Display *display;
7822 XErrorEvent *error;
7824 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7825 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7826 else
7827 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7828 return 0;
7831 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7832 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7833 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7835 static int
7836 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7837 Display *display;
7839 char buf[256];
7841 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7842 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7843 return 0;
7846 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7848 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7849 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7850 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7851 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7853 Lisp_Object
7854 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7855 struct frame *f;
7856 register char *fontname;
7858 struct font_info *fontp
7859 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7861 if (!fontp)
7862 return Qnil;
7864 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7865 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7866 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7868 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (f));
7869 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7871 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7873 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7874 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7876 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7877 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7878 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7880 else
7882 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7883 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7886 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7887 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7889 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7890 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7891 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7892 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7893 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7894 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7896 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7897 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7898 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7899 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7900 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7903 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7906 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7907 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7908 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7909 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7911 Lisp_Object
7912 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7913 struct frame *f;
7914 char *fontsetname;
7916 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7917 Lisp_Object result;
7919 if (fontset < 0)
7920 return Qnil;
7922 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7923 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7924 to do. */
7925 return fontset_name (fontset);
7927 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7929 if (!STRINGP (result))
7930 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7931 return Qnil;
7933 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7934 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7936 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7937 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7938 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7939 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7940 #endif
7942 return build_string (fontsetname);
7946 /***********************************************************************
7947 X Input Methods
7948 ***********************************************************************/
7950 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7952 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7954 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7955 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7956 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7958 static void
7959 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7960 XIM xim;
7961 XPointer client_data;
7962 XPointer call_data;
7964 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7965 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7967 BLOCK_INPUT;
7969 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7970 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7972 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7973 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7975 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7976 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
7978 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
7979 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
7984 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7985 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7986 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7987 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7990 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7992 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7993 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7994 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7995 #endif
7997 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7998 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8000 static void
8001 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8002 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8003 char *resource_name;
8005 XIM xim;
8007 if (use_xim)
8009 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8010 EMACS_CLASS);
8011 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8013 if (xim)
8015 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8016 XIMCallback destroy;
8017 #endif
8019 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8020 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8022 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8023 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8024 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8025 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8026 #endif
8030 else
8031 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8035 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8037 struct xim_inst_t
8039 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8040 char *resource_name;
8043 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8044 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8045 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8046 when the callback was registered. */
8048 static void
8049 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8050 Display *display;
8051 XPointer client_data;
8052 XPointer call_data;
8054 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8055 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8057 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8058 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8059 return;
8061 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8063 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8064 as they have no XIC. */
8065 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8067 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8069 BLOCK_INPUT;
8070 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8072 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8074 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8075 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8077 create_frame_xic (f);
8078 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8079 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8080 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8082 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8083 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8088 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8092 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8095 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8096 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8097 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8098 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8100 static void
8101 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8102 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8103 char *resource_name;
8105 if (use_xim)
8107 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8108 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8109 int len;
8111 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8112 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8113 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8114 len = strlen (resource_name);
8115 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8116 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8117 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8118 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8119 xim_instantiate_callback,
8120 /* Fixme: This is XPointer in
8121 XFree86 but (XPointer *) on
8122 Tru64, at least. */
8123 (XPointer) xim_inst);
8124 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8125 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8126 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8127 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8130 else
8131 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8135 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8137 static void
8138 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8139 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8141 if (use_xim)
8143 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8144 if (dpyinfo->display)
8145 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8146 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8147 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8148 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8149 if (dpyinfo->display)
8150 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8151 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8152 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8156 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8160 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8161 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8163 void
8164 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8165 struct frame *f;
8167 Window child;
8168 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8169 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8170 int this_window;
8172 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8173 is already for the top-left corner. */
8174 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8175 return;
8177 this_window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8179 /* Find the position of the outside upper-left corner of
8180 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
8181 But do this only if we will need the results. */
8182 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8184 int count;
8186 BLOCK_INPUT;
8187 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8188 while (1)
8190 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8191 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8193 /* From-window, to-window. */
8194 this_window,
8195 f->output_data.x->parent_desc,
8197 /* From-position, to-position. */
8198 0, 0, &win_x, &win_y,
8200 /* Child of win. */
8201 &child);
8202 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
8204 Window newroot, newparent = 0xdeadbeef;
8205 Window *newchildren;
8206 unsigned int nchildren;
8208 if (! XQueryTree (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), this_window, &newroot,
8209 &newparent, &newchildren, &nchildren))
8210 break;
8212 XFree ((char *) newchildren);
8214 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = newparent;
8216 else
8217 break;
8220 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
8221 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8224 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8225 position that fits on the screen. */
8226 if (flags & XNegative)
8227 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8228 - 2 * f->border_width - win_x
8229 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
8230 + f->left_pos);
8233 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8235 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8236 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8237 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8239 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8240 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8241 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8242 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8243 is right, though.
8245 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8246 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8248 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8249 #endif
8251 if (flags & YNegative)
8252 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
8253 - 2 * f->border_width
8254 - win_y
8255 - height
8256 + f->top_pos);
8259 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8260 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8261 so the flags should correspond. */
8262 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8265 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8266 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8267 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8268 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8269 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8271 void
8272 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8273 struct frame *f;
8274 register int xoff, yoff;
8275 int change_gravity;
8277 int modified_top, modified_left;
8279 if (change_gravity > 0)
8281 f->top_pos = yoff;
8282 f->left_pos = xoff;
8283 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8284 if (xoff < 0)
8285 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8286 if (yoff < 0)
8287 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8288 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8290 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8292 BLOCK_INPUT;
8293 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8295 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8296 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8297 #if 0 /* Running on psilocin (Debian), and displaying on the NCD X-terminal,
8298 this seems to be unnecessary and incorrect. rms, 4/17/97. */
8299 /* It is a mystery why we need to add the border_width here
8300 when the frame is already visible, but experiment says we do. */
8301 if (change_gravity != 0)
8303 modified_left += f->border_width;
8304 modified_top += f->border_width;
8306 #endif
8308 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8309 modified_left, modified_top);
8310 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8313 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8314 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8315 static void
8316 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8317 struct frame *f;
8319 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8321 int width, height, ign;
8323 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8325 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8327 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8328 when setting WM manager hints.
8329 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8330 x_check_fullscreen_move. */
8331 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8333 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8334 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8335 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8337 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8338 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8343 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8344 the window. This is done in xfns.c.
8345 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8346 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8347 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8348 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8349 static void
8350 x_check_fullscreen_move (f)
8351 struct frame *f;
8353 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT)
8355 int expect_top = f->top_pos;
8356 int expect_left = f->left_pos;
8358 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8359 expect_top = 0;
8360 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8361 expect_left = 0;
8363 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8364 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
8366 /* Just do this once */
8367 f->want_fullscreen &= ~FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT;
8372 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8373 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8374 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8375 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8377 static void
8378 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8379 struct frame *f;
8380 int change_gravity;
8381 int cols, rows;
8383 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8385 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8386 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8387 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8389 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8390 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8391 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8393 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8395 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8396 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8398 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8399 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8401 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8402 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8403 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8405 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8406 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8407 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8408 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8410 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8411 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8412 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8413 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8414 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8416 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8417 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8418 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8419 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8420 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8422 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8423 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8424 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8425 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8426 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8428 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8432 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8433 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8434 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8435 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8437 void
8438 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8439 struct frame *f;
8440 int change_gravity;
8441 int cols, rows;
8443 BLOCK_INPUT;
8445 #ifdef USE_GTK
8446 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8447 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8448 else
8449 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8450 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8452 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8454 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8455 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8456 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8457 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8458 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8459 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8460 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8461 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8462 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8464 else
8465 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8467 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8469 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8471 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8473 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8474 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8476 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8477 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8478 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8479 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8480 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8482 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8485 /* Mouse warping. */
8487 void
8488 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8489 struct frame *f;
8490 int x, y;
8492 int pix_x, pix_y;
8494 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8495 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8497 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8498 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8500 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8501 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8503 BLOCK_INPUT;
8505 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8506 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8507 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8510 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8512 void
8513 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8514 struct frame *f;
8515 int pix_x, pix_y;
8517 BLOCK_INPUT;
8519 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8520 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8521 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8524 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8526 void
8527 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8528 struct frame *f;
8530 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8531 x_raise_frame (f);
8532 #endif
8533 #if 0
8534 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8535 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8536 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8537 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8538 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8539 #endif /* ! 0 */
8542 void
8543 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8544 struct frame *f;
8546 #if 0
8547 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8548 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8549 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8550 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8551 #endif /* ! 0 */
8554 /* Raise frame F. */
8556 void
8557 x_raise_frame (f)
8558 struct frame *f;
8560 if (f->async_visible)
8562 BLOCK_INPUT;
8563 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8564 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8565 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8569 /* Lower frame F. */
8571 void
8572 x_lower_frame (f)
8573 struct frame *f;
8575 if (f->async_visible)
8577 BLOCK_INPUT;
8578 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8579 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8580 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8584 static void
8585 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8586 FRAME_PTR f;
8587 int raise_flag;
8589 if (raise_flag)
8590 x_raise_frame (f);
8591 else
8592 x_lower_frame (f);
8595 /* Change of visibility. */
8597 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8598 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8599 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8600 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8601 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8602 finishes with it. */
8604 void
8605 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8606 struct frame *f;
8608 Lisp_Object type;
8609 int original_top, original_left;
8610 int retry_count = 2;
8612 retry:
8614 BLOCK_INPUT;
8616 type = x_icon_type (f);
8617 if (!NILP (type))
8618 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8620 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8622 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8623 call x_set_offset a second time
8624 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8625 before the window gets really visible. */
8626 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8627 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8628 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8630 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8632 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8633 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8634 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8635 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8636 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8637 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8638 #ifdef USE_GTK
8639 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8640 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8641 #else
8642 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8643 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8644 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8645 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8646 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8647 to come back ok without this. */
8648 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8649 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8650 #endif
8653 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8655 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8656 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8657 so that incoming events are handled. */
8659 Lisp_Object frame;
8660 int count;
8661 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8662 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8663 will set it when they are handled. */
8664 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8666 original_left = f->left_pos;
8667 original_top = f->top_pos;
8669 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8670 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8672 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8674 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8675 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8676 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8677 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8679 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8680 because the window manager may choose the position
8681 and we don't want to override it. */
8683 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8684 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8685 && previously_visible)
8687 Drawable rootw;
8688 int x, y;
8689 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8691 BLOCK_INPUT;
8693 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8694 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8695 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8696 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8697 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8698 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8699 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8700 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8701 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8703 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8704 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8705 original_left, original_top);
8707 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8710 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8712 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8713 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8714 MapNotify at all.. */
8715 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8716 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8718 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8719 x_sync (f);
8721 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8722 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8723 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8724 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8725 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8726 probably a bug. */
8727 if (input_polling_used ())
8729 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8730 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8731 handler reset it. */
8732 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8733 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8734 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8735 poll_for_input_1 ();
8736 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8739 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8740 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8743 /* 2000-09-28: In
8745 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8746 (iconify-frame f)
8747 (raise-frame f))
8749 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8750 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8751 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8752 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8754 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8755 goto retry;
8759 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8761 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8763 void
8764 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8765 struct frame *f;
8767 Window window;
8769 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8770 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8772 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8773 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8774 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8776 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8777 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8778 return;
8779 #endif
8781 BLOCK_INPUT;
8783 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8784 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8785 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8786 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8787 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8788 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8790 #ifdef USE_GTK
8791 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8792 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8793 else
8794 #endif
8796 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8798 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8799 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8801 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8802 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8804 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8806 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8807 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8809 XEvent unmap;
8811 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8812 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8813 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8814 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8815 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8816 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8817 False,
8818 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8819 &unmap))
8821 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8822 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8826 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8827 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8828 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8831 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8832 just by the event that we get from the server.
8833 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8834 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8835 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8836 f->visible = 0;
8837 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8838 f->async_visible = 0;
8839 f->async_iconified = 0;
8841 x_sync (f);
8843 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8846 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8848 void
8849 x_iconify_frame (f)
8850 struct frame *f;
8852 int result;
8853 Lisp_Object type;
8855 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8856 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8857 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8859 if (f->async_iconified)
8860 return;
8862 BLOCK_INPUT;
8864 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8866 type = x_icon_type (f);
8867 if (!NILP (type))
8868 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8870 #ifdef USE_GTK
8871 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8873 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8874 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8876 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8877 f->iconified = 1;
8878 f->visible = 1;
8879 f->async_iconified = 1;
8880 f->async_visible = 0;
8881 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8882 return;
8884 #endif
8886 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8888 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8890 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8891 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8892 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8893 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8894 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8895 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8896 so we have to record it here. */
8897 f->iconified = 1;
8898 f->visible = 1;
8899 f->async_iconified = 1;
8900 f->async_visible = 0;
8901 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8902 return;
8905 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8906 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8907 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8908 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8910 if (!result)
8911 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8913 f->async_iconified = 1;
8914 f->async_visible = 0;
8917 BLOCK_INPUT;
8918 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8919 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8920 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8922 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8923 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8924 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8925 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8927 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8928 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8930 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8931 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8933 XEvent message;
8935 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8936 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8937 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8938 message.xclient.format = 32;
8939 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8941 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8942 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8943 False,
8944 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8945 &message))
8947 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8948 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8952 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8953 IconicState. */
8954 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8956 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8958 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8959 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8962 f->async_iconified = 1;
8963 f->async_visible = 0;
8965 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8966 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8967 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8971 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8973 void
8974 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8975 struct frame *f;
8977 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8978 Lisp_Object bar;
8979 struct scroll_bar *b;
8981 BLOCK_INPUT;
8983 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8984 commands to the X server. */
8985 if (dpyinfo->display)
8987 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8988 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8990 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8991 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8992 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8993 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8994 toolkit scroll bars. */
8995 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8997 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8998 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9000 #endif
9002 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9003 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9004 free_frame_xic (f);
9005 #endif
9007 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9008 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9010 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9011 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9013 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9014 we are using a toolkit. */
9015 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9016 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9018 free_frame_menubar (f);
9019 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9021 #ifdef USE_GTK
9022 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9023 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9024 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9026 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9027 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9028 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9030 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9032 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9033 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9034 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9036 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9037 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
9038 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9039 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9040 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9041 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9043 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9044 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9045 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9046 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9047 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9048 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9049 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9050 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9051 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9052 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9053 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9054 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9055 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9056 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9057 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9059 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9060 free_frame_faces (f);
9062 x_free_gcs (f);
9063 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9066 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9067 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9069 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9070 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9072 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9073 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9074 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9075 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9076 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9077 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9079 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9081 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9082 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9083 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9084 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9085 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9086 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9087 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9090 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9094 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9096 void
9097 x_destroy_window (f)
9098 struct frame *f;
9100 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9102 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9103 commands to the X server. */
9104 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9105 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9107 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9111 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9113 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9114 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9115 that the window now has.
9116 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9117 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9118 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9120 #ifndef USE_GTK
9121 void
9122 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9123 struct frame *f;
9124 long flags;
9125 int user_position;
9127 XSizeHints size_hints;
9129 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9130 Arg al[2];
9131 int ac = 0;
9132 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9133 #endif
9135 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9137 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9138 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9140 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9141 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9143 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9144 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9145 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9146 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9147 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9148 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9149 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9150 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9151 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9152 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9154 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9155 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9156 size_hints.max_width
9157 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9158 size_hints.max_height
9159 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9161 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9163 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9164 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9165 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9167 int base_width, base_height;
9168 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9170 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9171 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9173 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9175 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9176 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9177 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9178 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9179 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9181 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9182 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9183 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9185 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9186 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9187 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9188 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9189 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9190 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9191 #else
9192 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9193 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9194 #endif
9197 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9198 if (flags)
9200 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9201 goto no_read;
9203 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9206 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9207 long supplied_return;
9208 int value;
9210 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9211 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9212 &supplied_return);
9213 #else
9214 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9215 #endif
9217 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9218 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9219 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9220 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9221 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9222 #endif
9224 if (flags)
9225 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9226 else
9228 if (value == 0)
9229 hints.flags = 0;
9230 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9231 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9232 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9233 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9234 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9235 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9236 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9237 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9241 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9242 no_read:
9243 #endif
9245 #ifdef PWinGravity
9246 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9247 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9249 if (user_position)
9251 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9252 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9254 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9256 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9257 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9258 #else
9259 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9260 #endif
9262 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9264 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9266 void
9267 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9268 struct frame *f;
9269 int state;
9271 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9272 Arg al[1];
9274 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9275 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9276 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9277 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9279 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9280 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9282 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9283 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9286 void
9287 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9288 struct frame *f;
9289 int pixmap_id;
9291 Pixmap icon_pixmap;
9293 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9294 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9295 #endif
9297 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9299 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9300 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9302 else
9304 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9305 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9306 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9307 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9308 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9309 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9310 best to explicitly give up. */
9311 #if 0
9312 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9313 #else
9314 return;
9315 #endif
9318 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9321 Arg al[1];
9322 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9323 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9326 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9328 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPixmapHint;
9329 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9331 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9334 void
9335 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9336 struct frame *f;
9337 int icon_x, icon_y;
9339 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9341 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9342 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9343 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9345 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9349 /***********************************************************************
9350 Fonts
9351 ***********************************************************************/
9353 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9355 struct font_info *
9356 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9357 FRAME_PTR f;
9358 int font_idx;
9360 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9364 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9366 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9367 to be listed.
9369 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9371 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9372 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9373 on how many fonts to match. */
9375 Lisp_Object
9376 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9377 struct frame *f;
9378 Lisp_Object pattern;
9379 int size;
9380 int maxnames;
9382 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9383 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9384 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9385 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9386 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9387 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9388 int count;
9389 int allow_scalable_fonts_p = 0;
9391 if (size < 0)
9393 allow_scalable_fonts_p = 1;
9394 size = 0;
9397 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9398 if (NILP (patterns))
9399 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9401 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9402 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9403 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9405 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9407 int num_fonts;
9408 char **names = NULL;
9410 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9411 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9412 The cache is an alist of the form:
9413 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9414 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9415 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9416 allow_scalable_fonts_p ? Qt : Qnil);
9417 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9418 if (!NILP (list))
9420 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9421 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9422 goto label_cached;
9425 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9427 BLOCK_INPUT;
9428 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9430 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9432 XFontStruct *font;
9433 unsigned long value;
9435 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9436 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9438 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9439 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9440 font = NULL;
9441 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9444 if (font
9445 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9447 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9448 int len = strlen (name);
9449 char *tmp;
9451 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9452 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9453 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9454 if (len == 0)
9455 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9456 else
9458 num_fonts = 1;
9459 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9460 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9461 simple var. */
9462 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9463 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9464 XFree (name);
9467 else
9468 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9470 if (font)
9471 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9474 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9476 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9477 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9478 if (maxnames < 0)
9480 int limit;
9482 for (limit = 500;;)
9484 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9485 if (num_fonts == limit)
9487 BLOCK_INPUT;
9488 XFreeFontNames (names);
9489 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9490 limit *= 2;
9492 else
9493 break;
9496 else
9497 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9498 &num_fonts);
9500 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9502 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9503 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9504 names = NULL;
9505 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9509 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9512 if (names)
9514 int i;
9516 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9517 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9518 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9520 int width = 0;
9521 char *p = names[i];
9522 int average_width = -1, dashes = 0;
9524 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9525 14 dashes, and the field value following 12th dash
9526 (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a auto-scaled font which
9527 is usually too ugly to be used for editing. Let's
9528 ignore it. */
9529 while (*p)
9530 if (*p++ == '-')
9532 dashes++;
9533 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9534 width = atoi (p);
9535 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9536 average_width = atoi (p);
9539 if (allow_scalable_fonts_p
9540 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0)
9542 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9543 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9545 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9546 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9547 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9548 >= 0))
9549 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9550 width of this font. */
9551 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9552 else
9553 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9554 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9559 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9561 BLOCK_INPUT;
9562 XFreeFontNames (names);
9563 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9567 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9568 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9569 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9571 label_cached:
9572 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9574 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9575 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9576 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9578 int found_size;
9580 tem = XCAR (list);
9582 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9583 continue;
9584 if (!size)
9586 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9587 continue;
9590 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9592 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9593 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9594 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9596 BLOCK_INPUT;
9597 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9598 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9599 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9600 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9602 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9603 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9604 thisinfo = NULL;
9605 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9607 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9608 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9610 if (thisinfo)
9612 XSETCDR (tem,
9613 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9614 ? make_number (0)
9615 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9616 BLOCK_INPUT;
9617 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9618 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9620 else
9621 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9622 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9623 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9624 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9627 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9628 if (found_size == size)
9629 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9630 else if (found_size > 0)
9632 if (NILP (second_best))
9633 second_best = tem;
9634 else if (found_size < size)
9636 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9637 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9638 second_best = tem;
9640 else
9642 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9643 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9644 second_best = tem;
9648 if (!NILP (newlist))
9649 break;
9650 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9652 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9653 break;
9657 return newlist;
9661 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9663 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9664 font table. */
9666 static void
9667 x_check_font (f, font)
9668 struct frame *f;
9669 XFontStruct *font;
9671 int i;
9672 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9674 xassert (font != NULL);
9676 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9677 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9678 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9679 break;
9681 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9684 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9686 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9687 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9688 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9689 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9690 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9692 static INLINE void
9693 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9694 XFontStruct *font;
9695 int *w, *h;
9697 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9698 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9700 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9701 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9702 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9703 if (*w <= 0)
9704 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9708 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9709 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9710 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9711 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9712 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9714 static int
9715 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9716 struct frame *f;
9718 int i;
9719 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9720 XFontStruct *font;
9721 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9722 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9724 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9725 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9727 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9728 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9730 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9731 int w, h;
9733 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9734 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9735 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9737 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9738 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9741 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9742 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9744 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9745 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9746 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9750 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9751 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9752 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9753 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9755 struct font_info *
9756 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9757 struct frame *f;
9758 register char *fontname;
9759 int size;
9761 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9762 Lisp_Object font_names;
9763 int count;
9765 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9766 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9767 we already have by comparing names. */
9768 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9770 if (!NILP (font_names))
9772 Lisp_Object tail;
9773 int i;
9775 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9776 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9777 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9778 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9779 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9780 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9781 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9782 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9785 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9787 char *full_name;
9788 XFontStruct *font;
9789 struct font_info *fontp;
9790 unsigned long value;
9791 int i;
9793 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9794 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9795 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9796 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9797 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9798 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9799 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9801 BLOCK_INPUT;
9802 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9803 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9804 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9806 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9807 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9808 font = NULL;
9809 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9811 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9812 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9813 if (!font)
9814 return NULL;
9816 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9817 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9818 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9819 break;
9821 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9822 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9823 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9825 int sz;
9826 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9827 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9828 dpyinfo->font_table
9829 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9832 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9833 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9834 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9836 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9837 BLOCK_INPUT;
9838 fontp->font = font;
9839 fontp->font_idx = i;
9840 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9841 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9843 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9844 full_name = 0;
9845 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9847 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9848 char *p = name;
9849 int dashes = 0;
9851 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9852 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9853 so don't use it.
9854 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9855 stored in them. */
9856 while (*p)
9858 if (*p == '-')
9859 dashes++;
9860 p++;
9863 if (dashes >= 13)
9865 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9866 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9869 XFree (name);
9872 if (full_name != 0)
9873 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9874 else
9875 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9877 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9878 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9880 if (NILP (font_names))
9882 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9883 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9884 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9885 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9886 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9887 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9888 Qnil);
9890 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9891 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9892 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9893 make_number (fontp->size)),
9894 Qnil)),
9895 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9896 if (full_name)
9898 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9899 Qnil);
9900 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9901 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9902 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9903 make_number (fontp->size)),
9904 Qnil)),
9905 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9909 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9910 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9911 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9912 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9913 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9914 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9915 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9916 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9917 fontp->encoding[1]
9918 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9919 /* 1-byte font */
9920 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9921 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9922 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9923 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9924 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9925 /* 2-byte font */
9926 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9927 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9928 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9929 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9930 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9931 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9932 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9933 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9934 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9935 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9936 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9937 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9938 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9940 fontp->baseline_offset
9941 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9942 ? (long) value : 0);
9943 fontp->relative_compose
9944 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9945 ? (long) value : 0);
9946 fontp->default_ascent
9947 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9948 ? (long) value : 0);
9950 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9951 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9952 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9953 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9954 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9955 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9956 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9957 return fontp;
9962 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9963 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9965 struct font_info *
9966 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9967 struct frame *f;
9968 register char *fontname;
9970 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9971 int i;
9973 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9974 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9975 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9976 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9977 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9978 return NULL;
9982 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9983 `encoder' of the structure. */
9985 void
9986 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9987 struct font_info *fontp;
9989 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9991 elt = Qnil;
9992 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9994 elt = XCAR (list);
9995 if (CONSP (elt)
9996 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9997 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9998 >= 0)
9999 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10000 >= 0)))
10001 break;
10004 if (! NILP (list))
10006 struct ccl_program *ccl
10007 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10009 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10010 xfree (ccl);
10011 else
10012 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10018 /***********************************************************************
10019 Initialization
10020 ***********************************************************************/
10022 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10023 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10024 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10025 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10027 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10028 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10029 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10031 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10032 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10033 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10034 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10035 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10036 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10037 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10039 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10041 static int x_initialized;
10043 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10044 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10045 the screen number from the server number. */
10046 static int
10047 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10048 const char *name1, *name2;
10050 int seen_colon = 0;
10051 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10052 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10053 int length_until_period = 0;
10055 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10056 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10057 length_until_period++;
10059 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10060 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10061 name1 += 4;
10062 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10063 name2 += 4;
10064 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10065 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10066 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10067 name1 += system_name_length;
10068 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10069 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10070 name2 += system_name_length;
10071 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10072 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10073 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10074 name1 += length_until_period;
10075 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10076 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10077 name2 += length_until_period;
10079 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10081 if (*name1 == ':')
10082 seen_colon++;
10083 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10084 return 1;
10086 return (seen_colon
10087 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10088 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10090 #endif
10092 struct x_display_info *
10093 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10094 Lisp_Object display_name;
10095 char *xrm_option;
10096 char *resource_name;
10098 int connection;
10099 Display *dpy;
10100 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10101 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10103 BLOCK_INPUT;
10105 if (!x_initialized)
10107 x_initialize ();
10108 x_initialized = 1;
10111 #ifdef USE_GTK
10113 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10114 int argc;
10115 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10116 char **argv2 = argv;
10117 GdkAtom atom;
10119 /* GTK 2.0 can only handle one display, GTK 2.2 can handle more
10120 than one, but this remains to be implemented. */
10121 if (x_initialized > 1)
10122 return 0;
10124 x_initialized++;
10126 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10127 argv[argc] = 0;
10129 argc = 0;
10130 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10132 if (! NILP (display_name))
10134 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10135 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10138 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10139 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10141 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10142 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10143 #endif
10145 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10147 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10148 fixup_locale ();
10149 xg_initialize ();
10151 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10153 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10154 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10156 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10158 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10159 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10160 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10162 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10163 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10164 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name(s, Qnil);
10166 if (! NILP (abs_file) && Ffile_readable_p (abs_file))
10167 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10169 UNGCPRO;
10172 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10173 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10175 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10176 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10177 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10178 errors with X11R5:
10179 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10180 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10181 So let's not use it until R6. */
10182 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10183 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10184 #endif
10187 int argc = 0;
10188 char *argv[3];
10190 argv[0] = "";
10191 argc = 1;
10192 if (xrm_option)
10194 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10195 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10197 turn_on_atimers (0);
10198 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10199 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10200 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10201 &argc, argv);
10202 turn_on_atimers (1);
10204 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10205 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10206 fixup_locale ();
10207 #endif
10210 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10211 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10212 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10213 #endif
10214 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10215 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10216 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10218 /* Detect failure. */
10219 if (dpy == 0)
10221 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10222 return 0;
10225 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10227 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10228 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10230 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10232 struct x_display_info *share;
10233 Lisp_Object tail;
10235 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10236 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10237 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10238 SDATA (display_name)))
10239 break;
10240 if (share)
10241 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10242 else
10244 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10245 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10246 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10248 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10249 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10250 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10251 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10252 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10253 BLOCK_INPUT;
10256 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10257 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10258 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10259 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10260 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10261 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10262 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10264 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10266 #endif
10268 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10269 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10270 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10272 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10273 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10274 x_display_name_list);
10275 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10277 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10279 #if 0
10280 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10281 #endif /* ! 0 */
10283 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10284 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10285 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10286 + 2);
10287 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10288 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10290 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10291 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10293 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10294 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10295 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10297 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10298 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10299 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10300 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10301 #else
10302 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10303 #endif
10304 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10305 all versions. */
10306 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10308 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10309 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10310 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10311 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10312 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10313 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10314 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10315 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10316 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10317 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10318 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10319 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10320 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10321 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10322 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10323 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10324 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10325 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10326 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10327 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10328 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10329 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10330 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10331 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10332 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10333 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10334 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10335 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10336 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10337 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10338 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10340 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10341 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10343 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10345 Lisp_Object value;
10346 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10347 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10348 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10349 Qnil, Qnil);
10350 if (STRINGP (value)
10351 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10352 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10353 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10356 else
10357 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10358 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10361 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10362 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10363 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10364 dpyinfo->resy = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10365 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10366 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10367 dpyinfo->resx = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10370 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10371 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10372 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10373 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10374 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10375 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10376 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10377 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10378 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10379 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10380 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10381 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10382 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10383 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10384 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10385 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10386 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10387 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10388 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10389 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10390 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10391 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10392 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10393 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10394 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10395 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10396 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10397 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10398 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10399 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10400 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10401 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10402 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10403 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10404 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10405 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10406 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10407 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10408 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10409 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10410 /* For properties of font. */
10411 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10412 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10413 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10414 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10415 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10416 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10417 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10418 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10420 /* Ghostscript support. */
10421 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10422 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10424 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10425 False);
10427 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10429 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10430 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10433 char null_bits[1];
10435 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10437 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10438 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10439 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10444 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10445 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10446 dpyinfo->gray
10447 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10448 gray_bitmap_bits,
10449 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10450 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10453 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10454 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10455 #endif
10457 #ifdef subprocesses
10458 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10459 if (connection != 0)
10460 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10461 #endif
10463 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10464 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10465 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10466 /* stdin is a socket here */
10467 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10468 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10469 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10470 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10471 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10472 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10474 #ifdef SIGIO
10475 if (interrupt_input)
10476 init_sigio (connection);
10477 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10479 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10480 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10481 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10482 so that Xt does not crash. */
10484 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10485 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10486 Font font;
10487 int count;
10489 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10490 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10491 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10492 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10493 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10494 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10495 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10496 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10497 abort ();
10498 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10499 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10500 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10502 #endif
10503 #endif
10505 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10506 for debugging X code. */
10508 Lisp_Object value;
10509 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10510 build_string ("synchronous"),
10511 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10512 Qnil, Qnil);
10513 if (STRINGP (value)
10514 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10515 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10516 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10520 Lisp_Object value;
10521 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10522 build_string ("useXIM"),
10523 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10524 Qnil, Qnil);
10525 if (STRINGP (value)
10526 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10527 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10528 use_xim = 0;
10531 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10533 return dpyinfo;
10536 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10537 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10539 void
10540 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10541 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10543 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10545 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10546 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10547 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10548 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10549 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10550 else
10552 Lisp_Object tail;
10554 tail = x_display_name_list;
10555 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10557 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10559 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10560 break;
10562 tail = XCDR (tail);
10566 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10567 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10569 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10570 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10571 else
10573 struct x_display_info *tail;
10575 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10576 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10577 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10580 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10581 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10582 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10583 #endif
10584 #endif
10585 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10586 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10587 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10588 #endif
10589 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10590 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10591 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10592 #endif
10594 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10595 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10596 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10597 xfree (dpyinfo);
10600 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10602 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10603 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10604 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10605 that slows us down. */
10607 static void
10608 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10609 struct atimer *timer;
10611 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10613 BLOCK_INPUT;
10614 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10615 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10616 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10620 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10623 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10625 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10627 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10629 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10630 x_produce_glyphs,
10631 x_write_glyphs,
10632 x_insert_glyphs,
10633 x_clear_end_of_line,
10634 x_scroll_run,
10635 x_after_update_window_line,
10636 x_update_window_begin,
10637 x_update_window_end,
10638 x_cursor_to,
10639 x_flush,
10640 #ifndef XFlush
10641 x_flush,
10642 #else
10643 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10644 #endif
10645 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10646 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10647 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10648 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10649 x_per_char_metric,
10650 x_encode_char,
10651 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10652 x_draw_glyph_string,
10653 x_define_frame_cursor,
10654 x_clear_frame_area,
10655 x_draw_window_cursor,
10656 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10657 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10660 void
10661 x_initialize ()
10663 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10665 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10666 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10667 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10668 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10669 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10670 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10671 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10672 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10673 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10674 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10675 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10676 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10677 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10678 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10679 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10680 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10681 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10682 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10684 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10685 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10686 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10687 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10688 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10689 off the bottom */
10690 baud_rate = 19200;
10692 x_noop_count = 0;
10693 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10694 any_help_event_p = 0;
10696 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10697 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10699 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10700 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10702 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10704 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10705 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10706 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10707 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10708 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10709 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10710 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10712 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10714 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10715 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10716 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10717 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10718 widgets don't behave normally. */
10720 EMACS_TIME interval;
10721 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10722 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10724 #endif
10726 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10727 #ifndef USE_GTK
10728 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10729 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10730 #endif
10731 #endif
10733 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10734 original error handler. */
10735 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10736 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10738 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10739 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10740 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10741 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10743 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10745 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10746 x_session_initialize ();
10747 #endif
10751 void
10752 syms_of_xterm ()
10754 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10755 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10757 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10758 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10760 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10761 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10763 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10764 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10766 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10767 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10768 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10769 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10771 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10772 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10774 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10775 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10776 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10777 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10778 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10779 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10780 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10782 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10783 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10784 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10785 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10786 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10787 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10788 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10789 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10790 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10791 #elif USE_GTK
10792 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10793 #else
10794 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10795 #endif
10796 #else
10797 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10798 #endif
10800 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10801 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10803 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10804 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10805 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10806 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10807 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10808 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10809 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10810 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10811 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10813 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10814 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10815 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10816 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10817 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10818 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10820 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10821 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10822 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10823 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10824 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10825 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10827 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10828 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10829 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10830 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10831 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10832 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10834 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10835 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10836 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10837 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10838 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10839 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10841 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10842 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10843 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10844 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10845 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10846 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10849 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */